doc: [1/3] uniform the texinfo syntax for commands definition
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} init
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @section Interface Drivers
2371
2372 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2373 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2374 available at run time.
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2377 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2378 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2379 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2380
2381 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2382 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2383 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2384 @end deffn
2385
2386 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2387 Displays status of RTCK option.
2388 Optionally sets that option first.
2389 @end deffn
2390 @end deffn
2391
2392 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2393 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2394 This has one driver-specific command:
2395
2396 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2397 Logs some status
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2402 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2403 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2404 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2405 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2406 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2410 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2411 or v2 (USB bulk).
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2414 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2415 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2416 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2417 @example
2418 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2419 @end example
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2423 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2424 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2428 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2429
2430 @itemize @minus
2431 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2432 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2433 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2434 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2435 @end itemize
2436 @end deffn
2437
2438 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2439 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2440 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2441 interface string or for user class interface.
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2445 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2446 @end deffn
2447 @end deffn
2448
2449 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2450 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2454 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2458 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2459 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2460
2461 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2462 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2463
2464 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2465 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2466
2467 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2468 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2469 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2470 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2471 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2472 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2473
2474 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2475 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2476 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2477 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2478 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2479
2480 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2481 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2482 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2483 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2484
2485 @itemize @minus
2486 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2487 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2488 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2489 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2490 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2491 switching data and direction as necessary
2492 @end itemize
2493
2494 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2495 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2496
2497 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2498 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2499 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2500 @example
2501 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2502 @end example
2503 @end deffn
2504
2505 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2506 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2507 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2508 during device selection.
2509 @end deffn
2510
2511 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2512 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2513 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2514 is connected to the host.
2515 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2516 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2517 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2521 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2522 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2523
2524 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2525 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2526 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2527 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2528 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2529
2530 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2531 @end deffn
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2534 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2535 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2536 @end deffn
2537
2538 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2539 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2540 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2541 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2542 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2543 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2544 and initially asserted reset signals.
2545 @end deffn
2546
2547 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2548 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2549 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2550 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2551 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2552 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2553 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2554 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2555 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2556 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2557 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2558
2559 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2560 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2561 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2562 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2563 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2564 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2565
2566 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2567 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2568 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2569 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2570 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2571 are always driven by the FTDI.
2572
2573 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2574 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2575 @var{name}.
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2579 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2580 @itemize @minus
2581 @item @option{0}, drive low
2582 @item @option{1}, drive high
2583 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2584 @end itemize
2585 @end deffn
2586
2587 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2588 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2592 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2593
2594 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2595 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2596 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2597 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2598 @itemize @minus
2599 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2600 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2601 @end itemize
2602 @end deffn
2603
2604 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2605 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2606
2607 @end deffn
2608
2609 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2610 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2611 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2612 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2613
2614 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2615 @itemize @minus
2616 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2617 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2618 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2619 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2620 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2621 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2622 @end itemize
2623
2624 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2625 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2626 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2627 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2628 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2629 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2630 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2631 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2632
2633 FT232R
2634 @itemize @minus
2635 @item bit 7 - RI
2636 @item bit 6 - DCD
2637 @item bit 5 - DSR
2638 @item bit 4 - DTR
2639 @item bit 3 - CTS
2640 @item bit 2 - RTS
2641 @item bit 1 - RXD
2642 @item bit 0 - TXD
2643 @end itemize
2644
2645 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2646 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2649 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2650 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2651 @end deffn
2652
2653 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2654 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2655 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2656 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2660 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2661 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2662 @end deffn
2663
2664 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2665 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2666 @end deffn
2667
2668 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2669 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2670 @end deffn
2671
2672 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2673 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2677 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2681 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2682 @end deffn
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2685 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2689 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2690 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2691 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2692 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2693 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2694 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2695 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2696 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2697 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2703 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2704 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2705 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2706
2707 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2708 processors which are being simulated.
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2711 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2712 sockets instead of TCP.
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2716 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2717 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2718 @end deffn
2719
2720 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2721 something like:
2722
2723 @example
2724 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2725 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2726 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2727 @end example
2728
2729 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2730 named mysocket:
2731
2732 @example
2733 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2734 remote_bitbang_port 0
2735 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2736 @end example
2737 @end deffn
2738
2739 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2740 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2741 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2742 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2743
2744 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2745 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2746 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2747 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2748 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2749 @end deffn
2750
2751 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2752 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2753 default values are used.
2754 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2755 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2756 @example
2757 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2758 @end example
2759 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2760 @example
2761 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2762 @end example
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2766 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2767 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2768 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2769 target board.
2770
2771 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2772 @example
2773 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2774 reset_config srst_only
2775 @end example
2776 @end deffn
2777
2778 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2779 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2780 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2781 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2782 @end deffn
2783
2784 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2785 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2786 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2787 @end deffn
2788
2789 @end deffn
2790
2791 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2792 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2793 This has one driver-specific command:
2794
2795 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2796 Display either the address of the I/O port
2797 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2798 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2799 This is a write-once setting.
2800 @end deffn
2801 @end deffn
2802
2803 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2804 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2805 transports.
2806
2807 @quotation Compatibility Note
2808 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2809 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2810 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2811 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2812 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2813 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2814 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2815 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2816 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2817 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2818 @end quotation
2819
2820 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2821 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2822 states.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2825 Display free device internal memory.
2826 @end deffn
2827 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2828 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2829 command version.
2830 @end deffn
2831 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2832 Display the device configuration.
2833 @end deffn
2834 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2835 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2836 power state.
2837 @end deffn
2838 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2839 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2840 @end deffn
2841 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2842 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2843 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2844 IP configuration.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2847 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2848 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2849 @end deffn
2850 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2851 Reset the current configuration.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2854 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2857 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2858 pairs.
2859
2860 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2861 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2862 @example
2863 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2864 @end example
2865 @end deffn
2866 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2867 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2868 pairs.
2869
2870 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2871 @example
2872 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2873 77a90000
2874 @end example
2875 @end deffn
2876 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2877 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2878 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2879 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2880 the serial number instead, if possible.
2881
2882 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2883 @end deffn
2884 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2885 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2886 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2887
2888 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2889 @end deffn
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2893 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2894 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2895 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2896 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2897 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2898 configuration script.
2899
2900 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2901 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2902 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2903 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2904 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2905
2906 Known limitations:
2907 @itemize @bullet
2908 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2909 and 2.7 MHz.
2910 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2911 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2912 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2913 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2914 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2915 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2916 communications with the target.
2917 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2918 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2919 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2920 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2921 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2922 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2923 @end itemize
2924
2925 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2926 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2927 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2928 @end deffn
2929
2930 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2931 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2932 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2933 @end deffn
2934
2935 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2936 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2937 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2938 target as a side-effect.
2939 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2940 @end deffn
2941
2942 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2943 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2944 version, and target voltage.
2945 @end deffn
2946 @end deffn
2947
2948 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2949 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2950 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2951 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2952 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2953
2954 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2955 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2956 This is a write-once setting.
2957 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2958
2959 @itemize @minus
2960 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2961 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2962 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2963 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2964 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2965 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2966 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2967 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2968 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2969 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2970 some versions of
2971 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2972 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2973 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2974 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2975 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2976 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2977 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2978 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2979 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2980 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2981 @end itemize
2982 @end deffn
2983
2984 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2985 Display either the address of the I/O port
2986 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2987 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2988 This is a write-once setting.
2989
2990 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2991 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2992 you may encounter a problem.
2993 @end deffn
2994
2995 @deffn {Command} {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2996 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2997 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2998 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2999 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3000 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3001
3002 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3003 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3004 @quotation Tip
3005 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3006 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3007 @example
3008 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3009 > adapter speed 500
3010 @end example
3011 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3012 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3013 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3014 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3015 large set of samples.
3016 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3017 @example
3018 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3019 @end example
3020 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3021 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3022
3023 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3024 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3025 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3026 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3027 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3028 be conservative.
3029 @end quotation
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3033 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3034 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3035 @end deffn
3036
3037 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3038 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3039
3040 @example
3041 adapter driver parport
3042 parport_port 0x278
3043 parport_cable wiggler
3044 @end example
3045 @end deffn
3046
3047 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3048 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3049 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3050 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3051 @end deffn
3052 @end deffn
3053
3054 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3055 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3059 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3060 @end deffn
3061
3062 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3063 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3064
3065 @quotation Note
3066 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3067 which are not currently documented here.
3068 @end quotation
3069 @end deffn
3070
3071 @anchor{hla_interface}
3072 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3073 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3074 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3075 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3076
3077 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3078 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3079 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3080 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3081 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3082 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3083
3084 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3085 Currently Not Supported.
3086 @end deffn
3087
3088 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3089 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3090 @end deffn
3091
3092 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3093 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3097 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3101 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3102 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3103
3104 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3105 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3106 ST-LINK server software module}.
3107 @end deffn
3108
3109 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3110 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3111 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3112 @end deffn
3113 @end deffn
3114
3115 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3116 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3117 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3118 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3119 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3120
3121 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3122 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3123 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3124 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3125
3126 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3127 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3128
3129 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3130 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3131 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3132
3133 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3134 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3135 ST-LINK server software module}.
3136
3137 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3138 @end deffn
3139
3140 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3141 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3145 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3146 @end deffn
3147 @end deffn
3148
3149 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3150 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3151 @end deffn
3152
3153 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3154 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3155 @end deffn
3156
3157 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3158 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3159 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3160 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3161 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3162
3163 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3164 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3165 XDS110 found will be used.
3166 @end deffn
3167
3168 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3169 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3170 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3171 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3172 @end deffn
3173
3174 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3175 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3176 version).
3177 @end deffn
3178 @end deffn
3179
3180 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3181 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3182 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3183 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3184 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3185
3186 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3187
3188 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3189 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3190
3191 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3192 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3193
3194 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3195
3196 @end deffn
3197 @end deffn
3198
3199 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3200 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3201 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3202
3203 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3204 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3205 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3206 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3207 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3208 configuration on exit.
3209
3210 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3211 pinout.
3212
3213 @end deffn
3214
3215 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3216 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3217 of the one which is most popular.
3218
3219 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3220
3221 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3222 pinout.
3223
3224 @end deffn
3225
3226
3227 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3228 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3229 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3230
3231 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3232 @end deffn
3233
3234
3235 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3236 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3237 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3238
3239 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3240 @end deffn
3241
3242
3243 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3244 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3245 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3246
3247 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3248 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3249 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3250
3251 @itemize @minus
3252 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3253 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3254 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3255 @end itemize
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3259 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3260 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3261 @end deffn
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264
3265 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3266 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3267 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3268 DPI server interface.
3269
3270 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3271 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3272 @end deffn
3273
3274 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3275 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3276 @end deffn
3277 @end deffn
3278
3279
3280 @section Transport Configuration
3281 @cindex Transport
3282 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3283 and the debug adapter you are using,
3284 several transports may be available to
3285 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3286 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3287 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3288 version of OpenOCD.
3289 @end deffn
3290
3291 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3292 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3293
3294 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3295 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3296 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3297 adapter's driver).
3298
3299 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3300 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3301 supported by the debug adapter.
3302
3303 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3304 transport, if any.
3305 @end deffn
3306
3307 @subsection JTAG Transport
3308 @cindex JTAG
3309 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3310 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3311 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3312 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3313 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3314 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3315
3316 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3317 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3318 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3319 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3320 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3321
3322 @subsection SWD Transport
3323 @cindex SWD
3324 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3325 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3326 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3327 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3328 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3329 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3330 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3331
3332 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3333 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3334 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3335 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3336 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3337
3338 @deffn {Command} {swd newdap} ...
3339 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3340 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3341 expected to change.
3342 @end deffn
3343 @deffn {Command} {swd wcr trn prescale}
3344 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3345 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3346 No parameters: displays current settings.
3347 @end deffn
3348
3349 @subsection SPI Transport
3350 @cindex SPI
3351 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3352 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3353 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3354 solution for flash programming.
3355
3356 @anchor{swimtransport}
3357 @subsection SWIM Transport
3358 @cindex SWIM
3359 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3360 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3361 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3362 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3363
3364 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3365
3366 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3367
3368 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3369 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3370 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3371 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3372 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3373
3374 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3375 @section JTAG Speed
3376 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3377 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3378 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3379 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3380 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3381 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3382 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3383 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3384 power management software that may be active.
3385
3386 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3387 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3388 target event handler.
3389 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3390 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3391 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3392 sets up those clocks).
3393 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3394 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3395 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3396 in the target config file.
3397 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3398 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3399 config file instead.
3400 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3401 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3402 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3403
3404 @example
3405 jtag_rclk 3000
3406 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3407 @end example
3408
3409 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3410 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3411 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3412 may not be the fastest solution.
3413
3414 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3415 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3416 which support adaptive clocking.
3417
3418 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3419 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3420 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3421 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3422 than the speed specified.
3423
3424 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3425 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3426 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3427 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3428
3429 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3430 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3431 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3432 JTAG clocking after setup.
3433 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3434 If the interface device can not
3435 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3436 @end deffn
3437
3438 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3439 @cindex adaptive clocking
3440 @cindex RTCK
3441 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3442 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3443 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3444 @example
3445 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3446 jtag_rclk 3000
3447 @end example
3448 @end defun
3449
3450 @node Reset Configuration
3451 @chapter Reset Configuration
3452 @cindex Reset Configuration
3453
3454 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3455 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3456 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3457 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3458 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3459 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3460 Please see the various board files for examples.
3461
3462 @quotation Note
3463 To maintainers and integrators:
3464 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3465 Normally the board configuration file
3466 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3467 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3468
3469 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3470 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3471 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3472 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3473 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3474 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3475 @end quotation
3476
3477 @section Types of Reset
3478
3479 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3480 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3481 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3482
3483 @itemize @bullet
3484 @item
3485 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3486 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3487 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3488 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3489 @item
3490 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3491 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3492 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3493 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3494 @item
3495 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3496 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3497 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3498 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3499 @item
3500 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3501 several other types of reset.
3502 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3503 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3504 There may be individual module resets.
3505 @end itemize
3506
3507 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3508 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3509 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3510 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3511 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3512 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3513 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3514 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3515 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3516
3517 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3518 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3519
3520 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3521 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3522 common issues are:
3523
3524 @itemize @bullet
3525
3526 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3527 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3528 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3529 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3530 when either of those signals is not connected.
3531 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3532 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3533 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3534 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3535
3536 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3537 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3538 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3539 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3540
3541 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3542 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3543 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3544 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3545 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3546 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3547 hardware debouncing.
3548 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3549 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3550
3551 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3552 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3553 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3554 to use push/pull output drivers.
3555 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3556 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3557 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3558 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3559
3560 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3561 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3562 issues (not limited to errata).
3563 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3564 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3565 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3566 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3567 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3568 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3569 @end itemize
3570
3571 There can also be other issues.
3572 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3573 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3574 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3575 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3576 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3577 Agreement (NDA).
3578
3579 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3580 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3581 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3582
3583 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3584 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3585
3586 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3587
3588 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3589 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3590 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3591 allowing it to be deasserted.
3592 @end deffn
3593
3594 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3595 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3596 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3597 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3598 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3599 @end deffn
3600
3601 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3602 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3603 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3604 allowing it to be deasserted.
3605 @end deffn
3606
3607 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3608 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3609 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3610 @end deffn
3611
3612 @anchor{reset_config}
3613 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3614 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3615 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3616 configuration scripts.
3617
3618 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3619 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3620 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3621 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3622 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3623 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3624 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3625 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3626
3627 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3628 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3629 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3630 -- may be specified at a time.
3631 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3632 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3633 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3634 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3635 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3636
3637 @itemize
3638 @item
3639 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3640 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3641 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3642 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3643 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3644
3645 @quotation Tip
3646 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3647 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3648 @end quotation
3649
3650 @item
3651 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3652 signal implementations.
3653 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3654 indicating everything behaves normally.
3655 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3656 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3657 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3658 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3659 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3660 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3661 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3662
3663 @item
3664 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3665 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3666 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3667 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3668 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3669 while SRST is asserted.
3670 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3671 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3672
3673 @item
3674 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3675 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3676 is required to use this option.
3677 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3678 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3679 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3680 be asserted before any target connection.
3681 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3682 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3683 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3684 @end itemize
3685
3686 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3687 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3688 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3689 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3690 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3691
3692 @itemize
3693 @item
3694 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3695 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3696 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3697 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3698
3699 @item
3700 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3701 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3702 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3703 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3704 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3705 @end itemize
3706 @end deffn
3707
3708 @section Custom Reset Handling
3709 @cindex events
3710
3711 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3712 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3713 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3714 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3715 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3716 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3717
3718 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3719 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3720 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3721 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3722 want to reset everything at once.
3723
3724 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3725 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3726 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3727 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3728 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3729 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3730 needs special attention.
3731
3732 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3733 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3734 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3735 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3736 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3737 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3738 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3739 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3740 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3741
3742 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3743 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3744 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3745 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3746 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3747
3748 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3749 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3750 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3751 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3752 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3753 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3754 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3755 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3756 or potentially some other value.
3757
3758 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3759 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3760 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3761 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3762 (or their associated targets)
3763 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3764
3765 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3766 they return.
3767 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3768 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3769 @end deffn
3770
3771 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3772 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3773 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3774 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3775 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3776 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3777 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3778 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3779 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3780 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3781 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3782 @end deffn
3783
3784 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3785 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3786 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3787 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3788 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3789 @end deffn
3790
3791
3792 @node TAP Declaration
3793 @chapter TAP Declaration
3794 @cindex TAP declaration
3795 @cindex TAP configuration
3796
3797 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3798 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3799
3800 @itemize @bullet
3801 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3802 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3803 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3804 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3805 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3806 start running that code.
3807 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3808 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3809 and missing connections.
3810 @end itemize
3811
3812 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3813 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3814 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3815 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3816 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3817
3818 @section Scan Chains
3819 @cindex scan chain
3820
3821 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3822 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3823 They also need to be added to
3824 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3825 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3826 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3827 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3828 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3829 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3830 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3831 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3832
3833 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3834 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3835 command, presented in the next chapter.
3836 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3837 debugging targets.)
3838 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3839
3840 @verbatim
3841 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3842 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3843 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3844 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3845 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3846 @end verbatim
3847
3848 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3849 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3850 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3851 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3852 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3853 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3854 until they are told to do so.
3855
3856 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3857 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3858 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3859 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3860
3861 @example
3862 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3863 @end example
3864
3865 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3866 by a given chip.
3867 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3868 and so forth.
3869 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3870 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3871 both inside a single chip and between them.
3872 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3873
3874 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3875 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3876 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3877 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3878 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3879 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3880 includes commands something like this:
3881
3882 @example
3883 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3884 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3885 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3886 @end example
3887
3888 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3889 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3890 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3891
3892 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
3893 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3894 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3895 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3896 @example
3897 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3898 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3899 @}
3900 @end example
3901 @end deffn
3902
3903 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
3904 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3905 and their status.
3906 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3907 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3908 but systems with a JTAG router can
3909 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3910 @end deffn
3911
3912 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3913 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3914
3915 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3916 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3917
3918 @section TAP Names
3919 @cindex dotted name
3920
3921 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3922 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3923 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3924 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3925 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3926 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3927 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3928 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3929
3930 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3931 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3932 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3933
3934 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3935
3936 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3937 @deffn {Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3938 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3939 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3940
3941 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3942 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3943 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3944 overridable.
3945
3946 @cindex TAP naming convention
3947 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3948 and should follow this convention:
3949
3950 @itemize @bullet
3951 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3952 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3953 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3954 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3955 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3956 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3957 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3958 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3959 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3960 with a single TAP;
3961 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3962 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3963 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3964 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3965 @end itemize
3966
3967 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3968
3969 @itemize @bullet
3970 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3971 @*The length in bits of the
3972 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3973 @end itemize
3974
3975 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3976
3977 @itemize @bullet
3978 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3979 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3980 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3981 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3982 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3983 (the TAP is linked in).
3984 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3985 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3986 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3987 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3988 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3989 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3990 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3991 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3992 values that were found but not included in the list.
3993
3994 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3995 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3996 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3997 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3998 hardware to find these values.
3999 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4000 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4001 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4002 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4003 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4004 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4005 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4006 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4007 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4008 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4009 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4010 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4011 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4012 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4013 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4014 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4015 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4016 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4017 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4018 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4019 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4020 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4021 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4022 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4023 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4024 @end itemize
4025 @end deffn
4026
4027 @section Other TAP commands
4028
4029 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4030 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4031 @end deffn
4032
4033 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4034 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4035 At this writing this TAP attribute
4036 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4037 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4038 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4039 See the next section for information about the available events.
4040
4041 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4042 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4043 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4044 @end deffn
4045
4046 @section TAP Events
4047 @cindex events
4048 @cindex TAP events
4049
4050 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4051 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4052 The other applies to debugger targets,
4053 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4054
4055 The TAP events currently defined are:
4056
4057 @itemize @bullet
4058 @item @b{post-reset}
4059 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4060 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4061 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4062 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4063 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4064
4065 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4066 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4067 of any particular target.
4068 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4069 @item @b{setup}
4070 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4071 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4072 @item @b{tap-disable}
4073 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4074 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4075 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4076 @item @b{tap-enable}
4077 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4078 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4079 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4080 @end itemize
4081
4082 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4083 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4084 contents to be accurate), you might:
4085
4086 @example
4087 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4088 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4089 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4090 @}
4091 @end example
4092
4093
4094 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4095 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4096 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4097 @cindex jrc
4098
4099 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4100 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4101 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4102 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4103 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4104
4105 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4106 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4107 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4108 be visible.
4109 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4110 ignores, such as:
4111
4112 @itemize
4113 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4114 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4115 TAPs receive new instructions.
4116 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4117 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4118 @end itemize
4119
4120 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4121 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4122 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4123 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4124
4125 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4126 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4127
4128 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4129 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4130 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4131 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4132 should define TAP event handlers using
4133 code that looks something like this:
4134
4135 @example
4136 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4137 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4138 @}
4139 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4140 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4141 @}
4142 @end example
4143
4144 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4145
4146 @example
4147 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4148 @end example
4149
4150 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4151 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4152 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4153 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4154
4155 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4156 If necessary, disables the tap
4157 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4158 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4159 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4160 and "0" if it is disabled.
4161 @end deffn
4162
4163 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4164 If necessary, enables the tap
4165 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4166 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4167 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4168 and "0" if it is disabled.
4169 @end deffn
4170
4171 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4172 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4173 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4174 and "0" if it is disabled.
4175
4176 @quotation Note
4177 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4178 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4179 @end quotation
4180 @end deffn
4181
4182 @anchor{autoprobing}
4183 @section Autoprobing
4184 @cindex autoprobe
4185 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4186
4187 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4188 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4189 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4190 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4191
4192 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4193 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4194 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4195 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4196 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4197 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4198 right when they come out of reset).
4199
4200 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4201
4202 @example
4203 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4204 reset_config trst_and_srst
4205 jtag_rclk 8
4206 @end example
4207
4208 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4209 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4210
4211 @enumerate
4212 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4213 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4214 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4215 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4216 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4217 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4218 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4219 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4220 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4221 that is discovered.
4222 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4223 register, it will report it.
4224 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4225 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4226 @end enumerate
4227
4228 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4229 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4230 that's a bit more complex:
4231
4232 @example
4233 clock speed 8 kHz
4234 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4235 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4236 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4237 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4238 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4239 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4240 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4241 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4242 @end example
4243
4244 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4245 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4246 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4247 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4248 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4249 and so forth.
4250
4251 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4252 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4253 @cindex DAP declaration
4254
4255 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4256 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4257 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4258 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4259 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4260
4261 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4262
4263 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4264 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4265 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4266 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4267 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4268
4269 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4270
4271 @itemize @bullet
4272 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4273 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4274 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4275 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4276 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4277 @end itemize
4278 @end deffn
4279
4280 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4281 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4282 for TCL scripting.
4283 @end deffn
4284
4285 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4286 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4287 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4288 @end deffn
4289
4290 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4291 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4292 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4293 initialization, too.
4294 @end deffn
4295
4296 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4297
4298 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4299 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4300 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4301 @end deffn
4302
4303 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4304 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4305 @end deffn
4306
4307 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4308 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4309 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4310 or set a new value @var{value}.
4311 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4312 @end deffn
4313
4314 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4315 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4316 @end deffn
4317
4318 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4319 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4320 value @var{value}.
4321
4322 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4323 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4324 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4325
4326 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4327 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4331 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4332 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4333 @end deffn
4334
4335 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4336 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4337 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4338 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4339 @end deffn
4340
4341 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4342 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4343
4344 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4345 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4346 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4347 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4348 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4349 for details.
4350
4351 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4352 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4353 the pattern:
4354 @example
4355 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4356 @end example
4357
4358 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4359 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4360 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4361 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4362 @example
4363 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4364 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4365 @end example
4366
4367 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4368 @example
4369 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4370 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4371 @end example
4372
4373 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4374 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4375
4376 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4377 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4378 example with a proper dap name:
4379 @example
4380 xxx.dap apcsw default
4381 @end example
4382 @end deffn
4383
4384 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4385 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4386 Disabled by default
4387 @end deffn
4388
4389
4390 @node CPU Configuration
4391 @chapter CPU Configuration
4392 @cindex GDB target
4393
4394 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4395 You can also access these targets without GDB
4396 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4397 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4398 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4399 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4400
4401 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4402 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4403
4404 @section Target List
4405 @cindex target, current
4406 @cindex target, list
4407
4408 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4409 where each member has a name.
4410 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4411 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4412 (plural!) command.
4413 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4414 look like with more than one:
4415 @verbatim
4416 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4417 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4418 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4419 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4420 @end verbatim
4421
4422 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4423 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4424 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4425 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4426 space seen by that current target.
4427 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4428 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4429 are examples; and there are many more.
4430
4431 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4432
4433 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4434 Returns the name of the current target.
4435 @end deffn
4436
4437 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4438 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4439 @example
4440 foreach t [target names] @{
4441 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4442 @}
4443 @end example
4444 @end deffn
4445
4446 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4447 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4448
4449 @deffn {Command} targets [name]
4450 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4451 command names are singular.}
4452
4453 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4454 targets in a user friendly form.
4455
4456 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4457 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4458 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4459 @end deffn
4460
4461 @section Target CPU Types
4462 @cindex target type
4463 @cindex CPU type
4464
4465 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4466 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4467 when calling @command{target create}.
4468 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4469 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4470 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4471 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4472 what core-specific commands may be available
4473 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4474 and more.
4475
4476 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4477 since there's a command to list them.
4478
4479 @anchor{targettypes}
4480 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4481 Lists all supported target types.
4482 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4483
4484 @itemize @bullet
4485 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4486 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4487 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4488 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4489 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4490 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4491 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4492 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4493 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4494 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4495 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4496 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4497 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4498 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4499 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4500 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4501 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4502 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4503 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4504 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4505 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4506 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4507 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4508 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4509 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4510 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4511 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4512 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4513 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4514 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4515 support for new CPUs.
4516 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4517 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}), and a fake ARM core will
4518 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4519 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4520 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4521 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4522 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4523 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4524 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4525 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4526 @itemize @minus
4527 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4528 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4529 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4530 @end itemize
4531 And two debug interfaces cores:
4532 @itemize @minus
4533 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4534 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4535 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4536 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4537 @end itemize
4538 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4539 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4540 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4541 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4542 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4543 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4544 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4545 @end itemize
4546 @end deffn
4547
4548 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4549 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4550 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4551 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4552 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4553 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4554 reflect design generations;
4555 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4556 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4557
4558 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4559 @section Target Configuration
4560
4561 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4562 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4563 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4564 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4565 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4566
4567 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4568 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4569 optional parts.
4570 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4571 command, created as part of target creation.
4572
4573 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4574 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4575 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4576 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4577 to be much more board-specific.
4578 The key steps you use might look something like this
4579
4580 @example
4581 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4582 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4583 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4584 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4585 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4586 @end example
4587
4588 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4589 on-chip SRAM.
4590 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4591 writes to target memory;
4592 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4593 GDB memory checksumming;
4594 and more.
4595
4596 @quotation Warning
4597 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4598 inaccessible when application code
4599 (such as an operating system)
4600 enables or disables the MMU.
4601 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4602 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4603 easy access to other addresses needed.
4604 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4605 @end quotation
4606
4607 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4608 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4609 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4610 controllers.
4611 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4612 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4613 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4614
4615 @deffn {Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4616 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4617 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4618 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4619 purposes including additional configuration.
4620
4621 @itemize @bullet
4622 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4623 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4624 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4625 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4626
4627 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4628 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4629 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4630 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4631 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4632 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4633 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4634
4635 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4636 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4637 @end itemize
4638 @end deffn
4639
4640 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4641 The options accepted by this command may also be
4642 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4643 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4644 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4645
4646 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4647 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4648 and changing its endianness.
4649
4650 @itemize @bullet
4651
4652 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4653 used to access this target.
4654
4655 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4656 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4657 create and manage DAP instances.
4658
4659 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4660 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4661
4662 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4663 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4664 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4665 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4666 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4667 same event name assigns only one handler.
4668
4669 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4670 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4671
4672 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4673 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4674 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4675 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4676 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4677 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4678 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4679
4680 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4681 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4682 or virtual address is being used.
4683
4684 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4685 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4686
4687 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4688 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4689 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4690 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4691 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4692
4693 @anchor{rtostype}
4694 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4695 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4696 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4697 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4698 @option{RIOT}
4699 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4700
4701 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4702 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4703 access the target for debugging.
4704
4705 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4706 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4707 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4708 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4709
4710 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4711 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4712 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4713 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4714 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4715
4716 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4717 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4718 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4719 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4720 command @command{gdb_port}.
4721 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4722
4723 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4724 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4725 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4726 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4727 @end itemize
4728 @end deffn
4729
4730 @section Other $target_name Commands
4731 @cindex object command
4732
4733 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4734 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4735
4736 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4737 Once a button is created a button
4738 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4739 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4740 configure it like this:
4741
4742 @example
4743 # Create
4744 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4745 # Modify
4746 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4747 # Query
4748 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4749 # Report
4750 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4751 @end example
4752
4753 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4754 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4755
4756 @example
4757 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4758 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4759 @end example
4760
4761 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4762
4763 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4764 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4765 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4766 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4767 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4768 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4769 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4770 They are not otherwise documented here.
4771 @end deffn
4772
4773 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4774 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4775 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4776 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4777 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4778 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4779 the target side uses raw memory.
4780
4781 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4782 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4783 The script orientation comes from working with data
4784 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4785 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4786 and neither store nor return those values.
4787
4788 @itemize
4789 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4790 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4791 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4792 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4793 @end itemize
4794 @end deffn
4795
4796 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4797 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4798 @command{$target_name configure}
4799 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4800 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4801 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4802 There are a few special cases:
4803
4804 @itemize @bullet
4805 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4806 event named @var{event_name}.
4807 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4808 two parameters.
4809 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4810 This is a special case because this is set using
4811 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4812 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4813 @end itemize
4814
4815 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4816 all the targets you might use something like this:
4817
4818 @example
4819 foreach name [target names] @{
4820 set y [$name cget -endian]
4821 set z [$name cget -type]
4822 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4823 $x $name $y $z]
4824 @}
4825 @end example
4826 @end deffn
4827
4828 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4829 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4830 Displays the current target state:
4831 @code{debug-running},
4832 @code{halted},
4833 @code{reset},
4834 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4835 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4836 @end deffn
4837
4838 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4839 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4840 currently associated with this target.
4841 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4842 @end deffn
4843
4844 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4845 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4846 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4847 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4848 @end deffn
4849
4850 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4851 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4852 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4853 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4854 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4855 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4856 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4857 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4858 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4859 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4860 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4861 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4862 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4863 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4864 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4865 @end deffn
4866
4867 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4868 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4869 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4870 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4871 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4872 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4873 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4874 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4875 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4876 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4877 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4878 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4879 @end deffn
4880
4881 @anchor{targetevents}
4882 @section Target Events
4883 @cindex target events
4884 @cindex events
4885 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4886 For example:
4887 @itemize @bullet
4888 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4889 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4890 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4891 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4892 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4893 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4894 to set up system clocks or
4895 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4896 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4897 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4898 @end itemize
4899
4900 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4901 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4902 @command{target create ... -event}.
4903
4904 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4905 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4906 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4907
4908 @example
4909 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4910 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4911 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4912 @}
4913 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4914 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4915 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4916 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4917 @}
4918 @end example
4919
4920 The following target events are defined:
4921
4922 @itemize @bullet
4923 @item @b{debug-halted}
4924 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4925 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4926 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4927 @item @b{early-halted}
4928 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4929 @item @b{examine-start}
4930 @* Before target examine is called.
4931 @item @b{examine-end}
4932 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4933 @item @b{examine-fail}
4934 @* After target examine fails.
4935 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4936 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4937 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4938 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4939 connect GDB to running target.
4940 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4941 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4942 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4943 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4944 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4945 is in RAM or read only memory.
4946 Default is @code{halt}
4947 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4948 @* When GDB disconnects
4949 @item @b{gdb-end}
4950 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4951 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4952 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4953 @code{reset init})
4954 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4955 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4956 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4957 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4958 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4959 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4960 @item @b{gdb-start}
4961 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4962 @item @b{halted}
4963 @* The target has halted
4964 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4965 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4966 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4967 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4968 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4969 @item @b{reset-assert}
4970 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4971 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4972 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4973 it instead of asserting SRST.
4974 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4975 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4976 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4977 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4978 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4979 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4980 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4981 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4982 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4983 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4984 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4985 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4986 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4987 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4988 released on the scan chain.
4989 @item @b{reset-end}
4990 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4991 @item @b{reset-init}
4992 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4993 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4994
4995 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4996 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4997 multiplexing, and so on.
4998 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4999 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5000 @item @b{reset-start}
5001 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5002 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5003
5004 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5005 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5006 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5007 @item @b{resume-start}
5008 @* Before any target is resumed
5009 @item @b{resume-end}
5010 @* After all targets have resumed
5011 @item @b{resumed}
5012 @* Target has resumed
5013 @item @b{step-start}
5014 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5015 @item @b{step-end}
5016 @* After single-step has completed
5017 @item @b{trace-config}
5018 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5019 @end itemize
5020
5021 @quotation Note
5022 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5023 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5024 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5025 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5026 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5027 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5028 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5029 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5030 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5031 check if the core has changed status.
5032 @end quotation
5033
5034 @node Flash Commands
5035 @chapter Flash Commands
5036
5037 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5038 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5039 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5040 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5041 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5042 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5043 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5044 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5045 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5046
5047 Flash Steps:
5048 @enumerate
5049 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5050 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5051 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5052 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5053 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5054 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5055 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5056 @item GDB Flashing
5057 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5058 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5059 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5060 @end enumerate
5061
5062 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5063 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5064 so that it can't boot.
5065 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5066 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5067
5068 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5069 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5070 @cindex flash configuration
5071
5072 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5073 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5074 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5075 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5076 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5077 see the driver-specific documentation.
5078
5079 @itemize @bullet
5080 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5081 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5082 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5083 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5084 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5085 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5086 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5087 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5088 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5089 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5090 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5091 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5092 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5093 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5094 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5095 commands to the flash controller.
5096 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5097 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5098 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5099 for more information.
5100 @end itemize
5101 @quotation Note
5102 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5103 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5104 @end quotation
5105 @end deffn
5106
5107 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5108 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5109 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5110 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5111 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5112 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5113 @end deffn
5114
5115 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5116 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5117 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5118 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5119 @end deffn
5120
5121 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5122 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5123 depends on the flash type.
5124 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5125 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5126 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5127 but most don't bother.
5128 @end deffn
5129
5130 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5131
5132 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5133 begins.
5134
5135 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5136 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5137 until the programming session is finished.
5138
5139 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5140 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5141
5142 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5143
5144 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5145 @cindex flash erasing
5146 @cindex flash reading
5147 @cindex flash writing
5148 @cindex flash programming
5149 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5150
5151 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5152 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5153 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5154 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5155 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5156
5157 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5158 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5159 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5160 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5161 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5162
5163 @quotation Note
5164 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5165 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5166 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5167 back to a flash bank.
5168 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5169 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5170 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5171 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5172 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5173 @end quotation
5174
5175 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5176 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5177 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5178 disabled first.
5179 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5180 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5181 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5182
5183 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5184 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5185 up to and including @var{last}.
5186 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5187 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5188 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5189 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5190 @end deffn
5191
5192 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5193 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5194 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5195 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5196 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5197 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5198 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5199 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5200 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5201 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5202 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5203 before erase starts.
5204 @end deffn
5205
5206 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5207 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5208 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5209 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5210 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5211 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5212 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5213 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5214 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5215 before issuing this command.
5216 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5217 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5218 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5219 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5220 @end deffn
5221 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5222
5223 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5224 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5225 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5226 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5227 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5228 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5229 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5230 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5231 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5232 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5233 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5234 @end deffn
5235
5236 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5237 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5238 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5239 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5240 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5241 @end deffn
5242
5243 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5244 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5245 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5246 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5247 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5248 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5249 @end deffn
5250
5251 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5252 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5253 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5254 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5255 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5256 @end deffn
5257
5258 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5259 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5260 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5261 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5262 to the base address for each section in the image.
5263 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5264 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5265 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5266 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5267 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5268 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5269 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5270 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5271 each image section.
5272
5273 @quotation Warning
5274 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5275 data you want to preserve.
5276 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5277 sections might be erased with no notice.
5278 @itemize
5279 @item
5280 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5281 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5282 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5283 @item
5284 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5285 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5286 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5287 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5288 @end itemize
5289 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5290 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5291 @end quotation
5292
5293 @end deffn
5294
5295 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5296 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5297 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5298 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5299 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5300 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5301 ordinary memory reads.
5302 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5303 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5304 check for successful programming.
5305 @end deffn
5306
5307 @section Other Flash commands
5308 @cindex flash protection
5309
5310 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5311 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5312 and display that status.
5313 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5314 @end deffn
5315
5316 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5317 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5318 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5319
5320 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5321 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5322 and possibly stale information.
5323 @end deffn
5324
5325 @anchor{flashprotect}
5326 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5327 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5328 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5329 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5330 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5331 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5332 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5333 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5334 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5335 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5336 @end deffn
5337
5338 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5339 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5340 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5341 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5342 @end deffn
5343
5344 @anchor{program}
5345 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5346 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5347 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5348 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5349 @end deffn
5350
5351 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5352 @section Flash Driver List
5353 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5354 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5355 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5356
5357 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5358 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5359 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5360
5361 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5362
5363 @itemize
5364 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5365 @end itemize
5366
5367 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5368 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5369 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5370 @example
5371 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5372 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5373 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5374 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5375 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5376 @end example
5377 @end deffn
5378
5379 @subsection External Flash
5380
5381 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5382 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5383 @cindex CFI
5384 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5385 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5386 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5387 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5388 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5389 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5390 configure a bus and its timings), or
5391 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5392 on the flash chip.
5393 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5394 speed up operation.
5395
5396 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5397
5398 @itemize
5399 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5400 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5401 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5402 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5403 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5404 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5405 @end itemize
5406
5407 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5408 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5409
5410 @example
5411 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5412 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5413 @end example
5414
5415 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5416 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5417 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5418
5419 @example
5420 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5421 @end example
5422
5423 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5424 @end deffn
5425
5426 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5427 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5428 @cindex SPI
5429 @cindex jtagspi
5430 @cindex bscan_spi
5431 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5432 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5433 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5434 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5435 accessed through JTAG.
5436
5437 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5438 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5439 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5440 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5441 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5442 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5443
5444 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5445 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5446 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5447 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5448 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5449 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5450 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5451 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5452
5453 @itemize
5454 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5455 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5456 @var{USER1} instruction.
5457 @end itemize
5458
5459 @example
5460 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5461 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5462 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5463 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5464 @end example
5465 @end deffn
5466
5467 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5468 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5469 @cindex xcf
5470 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5471 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5472 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5473 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5474 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5475
5476 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5477 command accepts additional parameters:
5478 @itemize
5479 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5480 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5481 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5482 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5483 in master mode.
5484 @end itemize
5485 @example
5486 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5487 @end example
5488 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5489 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5490 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5491 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5492 dedicated sector.
5493 @end deffn
5494
5495 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5496 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5497 button.
5498 @example
5499 xcf configure 0
5500 @end example
5501 @end deffn
5502
5503 Additional driver notes:
5504 @itemize
5505 @item Only single revision supported.
5506 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5507 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5508 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5509 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5510 @end itemize
5511 @end deffn
5512
5513 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5514 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5515 @cindex SPIFI
5516 @cindex lpcspifi
5517 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5518 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5519 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5520
5521 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5522 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5523 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5524 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5525 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5526
5527 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5528 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5529 are configured by the driver.
5530
5531 @example
5532 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5533 @end example
5534
5535 @end deffn
5536
5537 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5538 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5539 @cindex SMI
5540 @cindex stmsmi
5541 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5542 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5543 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5544 SPI flash devices.
5545 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5546 flash devices can be connected.
5547
5548 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5549 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5550 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5551 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5552 the flash content.
5553
5554 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5555 to identify the memory bank.
5556 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5557 flash size, are detected automatically.
5558
5559 @example
5560 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5561 @end example
5562
5563 @end deffn
5564
5565 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmqspi
5566 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5567 @cindex QuadSPI
5568 @cindex OctoSPI
5569 @cindex stmqspi
5570 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5571 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5572 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5573 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5574 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5575 mode is not.
5576
5577 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5578 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5579 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5580 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5581
5582 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5583 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5584 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5585
5586 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5587 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5588 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5589 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5590 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5591 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5592
5593 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5594 but only after proper controller initialization as decribed above. However,
5595 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5596 should be avoided.
5597
5598 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5599 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5600 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5601 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5602 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5603 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5604
5605 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5606 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5607 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5608 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5609 persist across openocd invocations.
5610
5611 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5612 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5613 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5614 required (see 'set' command).
5615
5616 @example
5617 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5618 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5619 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5620 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5621 @end example
5622
5623 There are three specific commands
5624 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5625 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5626 chip specific write protection engaged.
5627 @end deffn
5628
5629 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5630 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5631 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5632 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5633 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5634 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5635
5636 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5637 which don't support an id command.
5638
5639 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5640 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5641 @end deffn
5642
5643 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5644 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5645 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5646 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5647 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5648
5649 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5650 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5651 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5652 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5653
5654 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5655
5656 To check basic communication settings, issue
5657 @example
5658 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5659 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5660 @end example
5661 for single flash mode or
5662 @example
5663 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5664 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5665 @end example
5666 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5667
5668 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5669 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5670 need a dummy address, e.g.
5671 @example
5672 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5673 @end example
5674 should return the status register contents.
5675
5676 @end deffn
5677
5678 @end deffn
5679
5680 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5681 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5682 Microcontroller platform.
5683
5684 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5685 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5686
5687 @example
5688 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5689 @end example
5690
5691 @end deffn
5692
5693 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5694 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5695 @cindex ath79
5696 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5697 chip selects.
5698 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5699 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5700 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5701 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5702 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5703 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5704
5705 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5706 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5707 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5708 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5709 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5710 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5711 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5712 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5713 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5714 with the default CS0.
5715 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5716 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5717 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5718
5719 @example
5720 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5721
5722 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5723 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5724 # distinguish the banks.
5725 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5726 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5727 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5728 @end example
5729
5730 @end deffn
5731
5732 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5733 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5734 @cindex fespi
5735
5736 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5737
5738 @example
5739 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5740 @end example
5741 @end deffn
5742
5743 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5744
5745 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5746 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5747 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5748 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5749 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5750 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5751
5752 @example
5753 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5754 @end example
5755 @end deffn
5756
5757 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5758 @cindex ambiqmicro
5759 @cindex apollo
5760 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5761 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5762 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5763 with the target using SWD.
5764
5765 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5766 the device class of the MCU.
5767 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5768 to set up the flash banks.
5769 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5770 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5771
5772 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5773 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5774 and the second bank starts after the first.
5775
5776 @example
5777 # Flash bank 0
5778 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5779 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5780 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5781 $_TARGETNAME
5782 @end example
5783
5784 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5785 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5786 are available to the user.
5787
5788 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5789
5790 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5791 Erase entire bank.
5792 @end deffn
5793 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5794 Erase device pages.
5795 @end deffn
5796 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5797 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5798 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5799 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5800 the flash.
5801 @end deffn
5802 @end deffn
5803
5804 @anchor{at91samd}
5805 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5806 @cindex at91samd
5807 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5808 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5809
5810 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5811
5812 The devices have one flash bank:
5813
5814 @example
5815 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5816 @end example
5817
5818 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5819 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5820 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5821 processor to be halted.
5822 @end deffn
5823
5824 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5825 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5826 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5827 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5828 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5829 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5830
5831 @example
5832 at91samd set-security enable
5833 @end example
5834 @end deffn
5835
5836 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5837 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5838 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5839 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5840 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5841 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5842 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5843 in order to disable this feature.
5844
5845 @example
5846 at91samd eeprom
5847 at91samd eeprom 1024
5848 @end example
5849 @end deffn
5850
5851 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
5852 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5853 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5854 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5855 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5856 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5857
5858 @example
5859 at91samd bootloader
5860 at91samd bootloader 16384
5861 @end example
5862 @end deffn
5863
5864 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5865 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5866 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5867 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5868 @end deffn
5869
5870 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5871 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5872 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5873 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5874 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5875 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5876 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5877 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5878
5879 @example
5880 # Read user row
5881 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5882 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5883 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5884 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5885 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
5886 # byte unchanged
5887 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5888 @end example
5889 @end deffn
5890
5891 @end deffn
5892
5893 @anchor{at91sam3}
5894 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5895 @cindex at91sam3
5896 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5897 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5898 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5899 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5900 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5901 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5902 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5903 chips are confirmed.}
5904
5905 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5906 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5907 the following fixed locations:
5908
5909 @example
5910 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5911 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5912 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5913 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5914 @end example
5915
5916 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5917 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5918 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5919
5920 @itemize
5921 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5922 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5923 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5924 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5925 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5926 @end itemize
5927
5928 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5929
5930 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5931 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5932 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5933 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5934 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5935 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5936 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5937
5938 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5939 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5940 @end deffn
5941
5942 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
5943 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5944 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5945 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5946 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5947 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5948 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5949 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5950 @end deffn
5951
5952 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5953 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5954 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5955 @end deffn
5956 @end deffn
5957
5958 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5959 @cindex at91sam4
5960 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5961 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5962 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5963 @end deffn
5964
5965 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5966 @cindex at91sam4l
5967 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5968 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5969 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5970
5971 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5972 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5973 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5974 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5975 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5976 @end deffn
5977 @end deffn
5978
5979 @anchor{atsame5}
5980 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5981 @cindex atsame5
5982 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5983 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5984 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5985
5986 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5987 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5988 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5989
5990 @example
5991 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5992 @end example
5993
5994 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
5995 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5996 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5997 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5998 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5999 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6000
6001 @example
6002 atsame5 bootloader
6003 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6004 @end example
6005 @end deffn
6006
6007 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6008 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6009 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6010 processor to be halted.
6011 @end deffn
6012
6013 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6014 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6015 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6016 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6017 @end deffn
6018
6019 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6020 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6021 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6022 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6023 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6024 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6025 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6026 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6027
6028 @example
6029 # Read
6030 >atsame5 userpage
6031 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6032 # Write
6033 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6034 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6035 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6036 # bytes)
6037 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6038 @end example
6039 @end deffn
6040
6041 @end deffn
6042
6043 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
6044 @cindex atsamv
6045 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6046 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6047 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6048 @end deffn
6049
6050 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
6051 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6052 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6053 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6054 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6055
6056 @example
6057 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6058 @end example
6059
6060 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6061 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6062
6063 @itemize
6064 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6065 @item @var{banks}
6066 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6067 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6068 @item @var{pages_size}
6069 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6070 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6071 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6072 @end itemize
6073
6074 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6075 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6076 will be autoconfigured.
6077 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6078
6079 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6080 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6081 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6082 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6083 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6084
6085 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6086 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6087 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6088 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6089 are not truly general purpose).
6090 @quotation Note
6091 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6092 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6093 @end quotation
6094 @end deffn
6095 @end deffn
6096
6097 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
6098 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6099 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6100 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6101 @end deffn
6102
6103 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
6104 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6105 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6106 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6107
6108 @example
6109 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6110 @end example
6111
6112 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6113 each single sector one by one.
6114
6115 @example
6116 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6117 @end example
6118
6119 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6120 @end deffn
6121
6122 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
6123 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6124 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6125 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6126 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6127 starts at address 0.
6128
6129 @example
6130 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6131 @end example
6132 @end deffn
6133
6134 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
6135 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6136 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6137 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6138 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6139 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6140 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6141 and programming the serial flash.
6142
6143 @example
6144 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6145 @end example
6146 @end deffn
6147
6148 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
6149 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6150 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6151 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6152 autoconfigures itself.
6153 @example
6154 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6155 @end example
6156 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6157 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6158 this via the following command:
6159 @example
6160 efm32 debuglock num
6161 @end example
6162 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6163 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6164 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6165 supported.}
6166 @end deffn
6167
6168 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
6169 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6170 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6171 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6172 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6173 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6174
6175 @example
6176 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6177 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6178 @end example
6179
6180 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6181 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6182 @end deffn
6183
6184 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6185 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6186 is an uncommon operation.}
6187 @end deffn
6188 @end deffn
6189
6190 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
6191 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6192 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6193 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6194 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6195 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6196 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6197
6198 @example
6199 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6200 @end example
6201 @end deffn
6202
6203 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6204 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6205 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6206 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6207 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6208 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6209 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6210 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6211 characters) ignored.
6212
6213 @example
6214 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6215 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6216 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6217 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6218 @end example
6219 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6220 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6221 @end deffn
6222
6223 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6224 @cindex kinetis
6225 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6226 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6227 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6228 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6229 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6230 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6231
6232 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6233 @itemize
6234 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6235 @end itemize
6236
6237 @example
6238 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6239 @end example
6240
6241 @deffn {Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6242 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6243 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6244 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6245 @end deffn
6246
6247 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6248 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6249 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6250 set by 'flash protect' command.
6251 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6252 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6253 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6254 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6255 with the rest of a flash image.
6256 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6257 @end deffn
6258
6259 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6260 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6261 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6262 @end deffn
6263
6264 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6265 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6266 and examine-fail event.
6267 @end deffn
6268
6269 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6270 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6271 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6272 @end deffn
6273
6274 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6275 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6276 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6277 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6278 command completes.
6279 @end deffn
6280
6281 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6282 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6283 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6284 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6285 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6286
6287 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6288 Program Partition command.
6289
6290 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6291 Reset the device after partition setting.
6292
6293 Show partition size:
6294 @example
6295 kinetis nvm_partition info
6296 @end example
6297
6298 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6299 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6300 @example
6301 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6302 @end example
6303
6304 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6305 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6306 @example
6307 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6308 @end example
6309 @end deffn
6310
6311 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6312 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6313 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6314 @end deffn
6315
6316 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6317 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6318 Command disables watchdog timer.
6319 @end deffn
6320 @end deffn
6321
6322 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6323 @cindex kinetis_ke
6324 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6325 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6326 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6327 autoconfigures itself.
6328 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6329
6330 @example
6331 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6332 @end example
6333
6334 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6335 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6336 @end deffn
6337
6338 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6339 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6340 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6341 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6342 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6343 @end deffn
6344
6345 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6346 Command disables watchdog timer.
6347 @end deffn
6348 @end deffn
6349
6350 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6351 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6352 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6353 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6354 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6355
6356 @quotation Note
6357 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6358 driver:
6359 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6360 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6361 @end quotation
6362
6363 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6364 which must appear in the following order:
6365
6366 @itemize
6367 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6368 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6369 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6370 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6371 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6372 LPC43x[2357])
6373 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6374 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6375 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6376 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6377 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6378 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6379 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6380 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6381 at which the core is running
6382 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6383 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6384 @quotation Note
6385 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6386 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6387 However, if you do provide it,
6388 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6389 @end quotation
6390 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6391 ROM IAP entry point.
6392 @end itemize
6393
6394 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6395
6396 @example
6397 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6398 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6399 @end example
6400
6401 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6402 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6403 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6404 @end deffn
6405 @end deffn
6406
6407 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6408 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6409 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6410 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6411 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6412 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6413
6414 @example
6415 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6416 @end example
6417 @end deffn
6418
6419 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6420 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6421 from NXP.
6422
6423 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6424 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6425 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6426 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6427 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6428 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6429 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6430 you start the PLL.
6431
6432 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6433
6434 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6435 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6436 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6437
6438 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6439 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6440 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6441 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6442 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6443 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6444 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6445
6446 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6447 @example
6448 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6449 @end example
6450
6451 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6452 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6453 @code{flash banks} command.
6454
6455 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6456 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6457 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6458 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6459 a known signature.
6460 Example:
6461 @example
6462 lpc2900 signature 0
6463 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6464 @end example
6465 @end deffn
6466
6467 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6468 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6469 saves it to a file in binary format.
6470 Example:
6471 @example
6472 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6473 @end example
6474 @end deffn
6475
6476 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6477 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6478 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6479 command:
6480
6481 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6482 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6483 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6484 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6485
6486 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6487 Example:
6488 @example
6489 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6490 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6491 @end example
6492 @end deffn
6493
6494 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6495 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6496 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6497 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6498 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6499 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6500 912 bytes.
6501 @quotation Attention
6502 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6503 @end quotation
6504 Example:
6505 @example
6506 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6507 @end example
6508 @end deffn
6509
6510 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6511 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6512 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6513 after the next power cycle.
6514 @quotation Attention
6515 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6516 @end quotation
6517 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6518 Example:
6519 @example
6520 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6521 flash info 0
6522 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6523 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6524 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6525 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6526 @end example
6527 @end deffn
6528
6529 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6530 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6531 effective after the next power cycle.
6532 @quotation Attention
6533 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6534 @end quotation
6535 Examples:
6536 @example
6537 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6538 @end example
6539 @end deffn
6540 @end deffn
6541
6542 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6543 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6544 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6545 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6546
6547 @example
6548 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6549 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6550 @end example
6551
6552 @itemize @bullet
6553 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6554 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6555 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6556 @end itemize
6557
6558 Example usage:
6559 @example
6560 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6561 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6562 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6563 @} else @{
6564 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6565 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6566 @}
6567 @end example
6568 @end deffn
6569
6570 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6571 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6572 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6573 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6574 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6575 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6576
6577 @example
6578 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6579 @end example
6580
6581 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6582 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6583 only the main program flash.
6584
6585 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6586 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6587 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6588 @end deffn
6589
6590 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6591 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6592 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6593 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6594
6595 To erase and program the BSL:
6596 @example
6597 msp432 bsl unlock
6598 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6599 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6600 msp432 bsl lock
6601 @end example
6602 @end deffn
6603 @end deffn
6604
6605 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6606 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6607 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6608 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6609 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6610 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6611 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6612 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6613 also have division into regions: main and info.
6614 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6615 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6616
6617 @example
6618 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6619 @end example
6620
6621 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6622
6623 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6624 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6625 @end deffn
6626
6627 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6628 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6632 Erase all userflash including info region.
6633 @end deffn
6634
6635 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6636 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6637 @end deffn
6638
6639 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6640 Check sectors protect.
6641 @end deffn
6642
6643 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6644 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6645 @end deffn
6646
6647 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6648 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6649 @end deffn
6650
6651 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6652 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6653 @end deffn
6654
6655 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6656 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6657 @end deffn
6658
6659 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6660 Show information about flash driver.
6661 @end deffn
6662
6663 @end deffn
6664
6665 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6666 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6667 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6668 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6669 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6670
6671 @example
6672 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6673 @end example
6674
6675 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6676
6677 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6678 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6679 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6680 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6681 code.
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6685 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6686 @end deffn
6687
6688 @end deffn
6689
6690 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6691 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6692 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6693
6694 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6695 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6696 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6697 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6698
6699 @example
6700 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6701 @end example
6702 @end deffn
6703
6704 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6705 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6706 and integrate flash memory.
6707
6708 @example
6709 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6710 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6711 @end example
6712
6713 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6714 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6715 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6716 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6717 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6718 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6719 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6720 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6721 @end deffn
6722 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6723 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6724 This will remove any Code Protection.
6725 @end deffn
6726 @end deffn
6727
6728 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6729 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6730 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6731 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6732 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6733
6734 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6735 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6736
6737 @example
6738 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6739 @end example
6740
6741 psoc4-specific commands
6742 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6743 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6744
6745 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6746 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6747
6748 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6749 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6750 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6751
6752 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6753 @end deffn
6754
6755 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6756 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6757
6758 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6759 @end deffn
6760 @end deffn
6761
6762 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6763 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6764 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6765 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6766 apart from the base address.
6767
6768 @example
6769 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6770 @end example
6771
6772 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6773 @quotation Attention
6774 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6775 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6776 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6777 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6778 @end quotation
6779
6780 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6781
6782 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6783 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6784 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6785 @end deffn
6786 @end deffn
6787
6788 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6789 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6790 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6791 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6792 apart from the base address.
6793
6794 @example
6795 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6796 $_TARGETNAME
6797 @end example
6798 @end deffn
6799
6800 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6801 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6802 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6803 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6804
6805 @example
6806 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6807 @end example
6808
6809 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6810
6811 @itemize
6812 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6813 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6814 @end itemize
6815
6816 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6817
6818 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6819 @quotation Attention
6820 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6821 after successful write.
6822 @end quotation
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6826 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6827 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6828 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6829
6830 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6831 @itemize @bullet
6832 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6833 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6834 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6835 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6836 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6837 row size: 512 bytes.
6838 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6839 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6840 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6841 operation will erase row automatically.
6842 @end itemize
6843
6844 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6845 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6846
6847 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6848
6849 @example
6850 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6851 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6852 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6853 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6854 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6855 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6856 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6857 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6858 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6859 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6860 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6861 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6862
6863 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6864 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6865 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6866 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6867 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6868 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6869 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6870 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6871 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6872 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6873 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6874 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6875 @end example
6876
6877 psoc6-specific commands
6878 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
6879 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6880 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6881 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6882 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6883 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6884 @end deffn
6885
6886 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6887 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6888 by @command{flash banks}.
6889 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6890 @end deffn
6891 @end deffn
6892
6893 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6894 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6895 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6896 and SWD interface.
6897 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6898 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6899
6900 @example
6901 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6902 @end example
6903
6904 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6905
6906 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
6907 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6908 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6909 @end deffn
6910
6911 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
6912 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6913 @end deffn
6914 @end deffn
6915
6916 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6917 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6918 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6919 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6920 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6921
6922 @example
6923 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6924 @end example
6925
6926 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
6927 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6928 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6929 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6930 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6931 disabled.
6932
6933 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6934 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6935 @quotation Warning
6936 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6937 applied to all of them.
6938 @end quotation
6939 @end deffn
6940 @end deffn
6941
6942 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6943 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6944 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6945 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6946 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6947
6948 @example
6949 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6950 @end example
6951
6952 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6953 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6954 the flash driver.
6955
6956 @example
6957 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6958 @end example
6959
6960 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6961 as per the following example.
6962 @example
6963 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6964 @end example
6965
6966 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6967
6968 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
6969 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6970 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6971 @end deffn
6972
6973 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
6974 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6975 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6976 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6977 @end deffn
6978
6979 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6980 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6981 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6982 @end deffn
6983
6984 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
6985 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6986 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6987 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6988 @end deffn
6989
6990 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6991 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6992 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6993 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6994 @end deffn
6995
6996 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
6997 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6998 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6999 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7000 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7001 @end deffn
7002 @end deffn
7003
7004 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
7005 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7006 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7007 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7008 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7009
7010 @example
7011 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7012 @end example
7013
7014 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7015 as per the following example.
7016 @example
7017 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7018 @end example
7019
7020 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7021 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7022 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7023 @end deffn
7024
7025 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7026 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7027 the flash driver.
7028
7029 @example
7030 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7031 @end example
7032
7033 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7034
7035 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7036 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7037 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7038 @end deffn
7039
7040 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7041 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7042 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7043 @end deffn
7044
7045 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7046 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7047 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7048 @end deffn
7049
7050 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7051 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7052 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7053 @end deffn
7054
7055 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7056 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7057 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7058 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7059 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7060 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7061 @end deffn
7062
7063 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7064 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7065 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7066 @end deffn
7067 @end deffn
7068
7069 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
7070 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7071 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7072 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7073 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7074
7075 @example
7076 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7077 @end example
7078
7079 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7080 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7081 the flash driver.
7082
7083 @example
7084 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7085 @end example
7086
7087 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7088
7089 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7090 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7091 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7092 @end deffn
7093
7094 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7095 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7096 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7097 @end deffn
7098
7099 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7100 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7101 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7105 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7106 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7107 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7108 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7109
7110 Example usage:
7111 @example
7112 # read OPTSR_CUR
7113 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7114 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7115 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7116 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7117 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7118 @end example
7119 @end deffn
7120
7121 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7122 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7123 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7124 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7125 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7126 will be touched).
7127
7128 Example usage:
7129 @example
7130 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7131 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7132 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7133 @end example
7134 @end deffn
7135 @end deffn
7136
7137 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
7138 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7139 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7140 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7141 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7142
7143 @example
7144 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7145 @end example
7146
7147 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7148 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7149 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7150 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7151 second bank.
7152
7153 @example
7154 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7155 @end example
7156
7157 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7158
7159 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7160 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7161 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7162 @end deffn
7163
7164 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7165 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7166 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7167 @end deffn
7168
7169 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7170 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7171 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7172 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7173 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7174 @end deffn
7175 @end deffn
7176
7177 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
7178 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
7179 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7180 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7181 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7182 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7183
7184 @example
7185 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7186 @end example
7187
7188 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7189 as per the following example.
7190 @example
7191 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7192 @end example
7193
7194 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7195 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7196 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7197 @end deffn
7198
7199 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7200 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7201 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7202 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7203
7204 @example
7205 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7206 @end example
7207
7208 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7209
7210 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7211 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7212 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7213 @end deffn
7214
7215 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7216 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7217 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7218 @end deffn
7219
7220 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7221 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7222 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7223 @end deffn
7224
7225 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7226 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7227 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7228 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7229
7230 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7231 @example
7232 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7233 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7234 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7235 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7236 @end example
7237
7238 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7239 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7240 @end deffn
7241
7242 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7243 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7244 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7245 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7246 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7247
7248 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7249 @example
7250 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7251 @end example
7252
7253 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7254 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7255 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7256 @end deffn
7257
7258 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7259 List the protected areas using WRP.
7260 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7261 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7262 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7263
7264 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7265 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7266 in single or dual-banks mode.
7267 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7268 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7269
7270 @end deffn
7271
7272 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7273 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7274 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7275 @end deffn
7276 @end deffn
7277
7278 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7279 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7280 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7281 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7282 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7283
7284 @example
7285 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7286 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7287 @end example
7288
7289 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7290 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7291 for the specified flash bank.
7292 @end deffn
7293 @end deffn
7294
7295 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7296 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7297 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7298 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7299 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7300
7301 @example
7302 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7303 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7304 @end example
7305
7306 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7307 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7308 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7309
7310 @itemize @bullet
7311 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7312 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7313 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7314 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7315 @end itemize
7316 @end deffn
7317
7318 @end deffn
7319
7320 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7321 @cindex str9xpec
7322
7323 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7324 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7325 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7326 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7327
7328 Here is some background info to help
7329 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7330 the str9:
7331 @enumerate
7332 @item
7333 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7334 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7335 @item
7336 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7337 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7338 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7339 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7340 @end enumerate
7341
7342 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7343 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7344 configured for flash bank 0.
7345 @example
7346 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7347 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7348 adapter assert srst
7349 # turn off target polling
7350 poll off
7351 # disable str9 core
7352 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7353 # read option bytes
7354 str9xpec options_read 0
7355 # re-enable str9 core
7356 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7357 poll on
7358 reset halt
7359 @end example
7360 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7361 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7362 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7363 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7364
7365 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7366
7367 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7368 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7369 @end deffn
7370
7371 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7372 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7373 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7374 @end deffn
7375
7376 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7377 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7378 erase the device.
7379 @end deffn
7380
7381 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7382 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7383 @end deffn
7384
7385 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7386 Configure str9 boot bank.
7387 @end deffn
7388
7389 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7390 Configure str9 lvd source.
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7394 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7395 @end deffn
7396
7397 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7398 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7399 @end deffn
7400
7401 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7402 Read str9 option bytes.
7403 @end deffn
7404
7405 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7406 Write str9 option bytes.
7407 @end deffn
7408
7409 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7410 unlock str9 device.
7411 @end deffn
7412
7413 @end deffn
7414
7415 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7416 @cindex swm050
7417 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7418
7419 @example
7420 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7421 @end example
7422
7423 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7424
7425 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7426 Erases the entire flash bank.
7427 @end deffn
7428
7429 @end deffn
7430
7431
7432 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7433 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7434 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7435 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7436
7437 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7438
7439 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7440 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7441 @end deffn
7442
7443 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7444 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7445 @end deffn
7446
7447 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7448 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7449 the flash clock.
7450 @end deffn
7451 @end deffn
7452
7453 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7454 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7455 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7456 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7457 correct bank config.
7458
7459 @example
7460 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7461 @end example
7462 @end deffn
7463
7464 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7465 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7466 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7467 @end deffn
7468
7469 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7470 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7471 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7472
7473 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7474
7475 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7476 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7477 @end deffn
7478
7479 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7480 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7481 @end deffn
7482
7483 @end deffn
7484
7485 @section NAND Flash Commands
7486 @cindex NAND
7487
7488 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7489 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7490 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7491
7492 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7493 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7494 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7495 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7496 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7497 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7498
7499 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7500 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7501 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7502 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7503 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7504 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7505 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7506 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7507 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7508 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7509
7510 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7511 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7512 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7513 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7514 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7515 every 512 bytes of data.
7516
7517 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7518 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7519 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7520 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7521 ECC mode is used.
7522
7523 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7524 @enumerate
7525 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7526 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7527 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7528 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7529 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7530 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7531 to access that device.
7532 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7533 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7534 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7535 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7536 de-brick a board.
7537 @end enumerate
7538
7539 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7540 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7541 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7542 are only 32 bits wide.
7543 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7544 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7545 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7546 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7547
7548 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7549 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7550 @cindex NAND configuration
7551
7552 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7553 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7554 OpenOCD has initialized.
7555
7556 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7557 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7558 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7559 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7560 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7561 they were a single (larger) device.
7562 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7563 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7564
7565 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7566 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7567 configuration files, not interactively.
7568
7569 @itemize @bullet
7570 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7571 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7572 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7573 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7574 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7575 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7576 commands to the NAND controller.
7577 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7578 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7579 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7580 for more information.
7581 @end itemize
7582 @end deffn
7583
7584 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7585 Prints a summary of each device declared
7586 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7587 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7588 @example
7589 > nand list
7590 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7591 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7592 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7593 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7594 >
7595 @end example
7596 @end deffn
7597
7598 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7599 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7600 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7601 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7602 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7603 it with most other NAND commands.
7604 @end deffn
7605
7606 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7607
7608 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7609 @cindex NAND reading
7610 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7611 starting at the specified offset.
7612 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7613
7614 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7615 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7616
7617 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7618 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7619 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7620
7621 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7622 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7623 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7624 method which handled that error correction.
7625
7626 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7627 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7628 @itemize @bullet
7629 @item no oob_* parameter
7630 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7631 @item @code{oob_raw}
7632 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7633 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7634 spare areas associated with each data page.
7635 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7636 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7637 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7638 @item @code{oob_only}
7639 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7640 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7641 spare areas associated with each data page.
7642 @end itemize
7643 @end deffn
7644
7645 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7646 @cindex NAND erasing
7647 @cindex NAND programming
7648 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7649 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7650 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7651 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7652 If those parameters are not specified,
7653 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7654 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7655
7656 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7657 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7658 block marker.
7659 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7660 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7661 @end deffn
7662
7663 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7664 @cindex NAND writing
7665 @cindex NAND programming
7666 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7667 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7668 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7669 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7670
7671 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7672 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7673
7674 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7675 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7676 past the end of the device.
7677 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7678 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7679 if that's being written.)
7680
7681 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7682 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7683 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7684
7685 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7686 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7687 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7688 @itemize @bullet
7689 @item no oob_* parameter
7690 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7691 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7692 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7693 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7694 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7695 @item @code{oob_only}
7696 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7697 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7698 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7699 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7700 @item @code{oob_raw}
7701 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7702 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7703 un-altered OOB.
7704 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7705 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7706 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7707 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7708 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7709 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7710 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7711 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7712 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7713 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7714 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7715 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7716 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7717 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7718 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7719 @end itemize
7720 @end deffn
7721
7722 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7723 @cindex NAND verification
7724 @cindex NAND programming
7725 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7726 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7727 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7728
7729 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7730 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7731
7732 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7733 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7734 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7735 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7736 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7737
7738 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7739 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7740 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7741
7742 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7743 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7744 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7745 be removed in a future release.
7746 @end deffn
7747
7748 @subsection Other NAND commands
7749 @cindex NAND other commands
7750
7751 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7752 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7753 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7754 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7755 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7756 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7757 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7758 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7759
7760 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7761 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7762 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7763 @end deffn
7764
7765 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7766 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7767 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7768 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7769 status for each block.
7770 @end deffn
7771
7772 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7773 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7774 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7775
7776 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7777 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7778 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7779 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7780 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7781
7782 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7783 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7784 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7785 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7786 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7787 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7788 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7789 @end deffn
7790
7791 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7792 @subsection NAND Driver List
7793 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7794 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7795 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7796
7797 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7798 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7799 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7800 address of the ECC controller.
7801 @example
7802 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7803 @end example
7804 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7805 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7806 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7807 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7808 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7809 @deffn {Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7810 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7811 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7812 @end deffn
7813 @deffn {Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7814 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7815 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7816 @end deffn
7817
7818 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7819 properly configured for input or output.
7820 @deffn {Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7821 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7822 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7823 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7824 @end deffn
7825 @deffn {Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7826 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7827 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7828 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7829 @end deffn
7830 @end deffn
7831
7832 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7833 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7834 chips from Texas Instruments.
7835 It takes three extra parameters:
7836 address of the NAND chip;
7837 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7838 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7839 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7840 @example
7841 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7842 @end example
7843 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7844 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7845 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7846 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7847 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7848 @end deffn
7849
7850 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7851 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7852 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7853 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7854 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7855 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7856 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7857 @end deffn
7858
7859 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7860 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7861 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7862 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7863 @end deffn
7864 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7865
7866 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7867 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7868 should work for this chip as well.
7869 @end deffn
7870
7871 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7872 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7873 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7874 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7875 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7876 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7877 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7878 @example
7879 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7880 @end example
7881 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7882 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7883 without parameter query status.
7884 @end deffn
7885 @end deffn
7886
7887 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7888 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7889 parameter: the address of the controller.
7890 @example
7891 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7892 @end example
7893 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7894 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7895 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7896 change any behavior.
7897 @end deffn
7898
7899 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7900 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7901 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7902 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7903 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7904 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7905 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7906 specialized commands.
7907 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7908 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7909 change any behavior.
7910 @end deffn
7911
7912 @node Flash Programming
7913 @chapter Flash Programming
7914
7915 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7916 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7917 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7918
7919 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7920 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7921
7922 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7923 @enumerate
7924 @item 'init' is executed.
7925 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7926 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7927 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7928 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7929 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7930 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7931 @end enumerate
7932
7933 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7934
7935 @example
7936 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7937 # are optional parameters
7938 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7939 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7940
7941 # binary files need the flash address passing
7942 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7943 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7944 @end example
7945
7946 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7947 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7948 @cindex PLD
7949 @cindex FPGA
7950
7951 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7952 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7953 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7954 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7955 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7956 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7957 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7958
7959 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7960
7961 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7962 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7963 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7964
7965 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7966 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7967
7968 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7969 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7970 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7971 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7972 behavior.
7973 @end deffn
7974
7975 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7976 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7977 @end deffn
7978
7979 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7980 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7981 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7982 @end deffn
7983
7984 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7985
7986 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7987 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7988 that particular type of PLD.
7989
7990 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7991 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7992 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7993
7994 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7995 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7996 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7997
7998 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7999 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8000 for FPGA @var{num}.
8001 @end deffn
8002 @end deffn
8003
8004 @node General Commands
8005 @chapter General Commands
8006 @cindex commands
8007
8008 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8009 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8010 commands are documented elsewhere.
8011
8012 Intent:
8013 @itemize @bullet
8014 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8015 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8016 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8017 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8018
8019 @item @b{From the human}
8020 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8021 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8022
8023 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8024 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8025 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8026
8027 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8028 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8029 port is 5555.
8030 @end itemize
8031
8032
8033 @section Server Commands
8034
8035 @deffn {Command} exit
8036 Exits the current telnet session.
8037 @end deffn
8038
8039 @deffn {Command} help [string]
8040 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8041 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8042 Not every command provides helptext.
8043
8044 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8045 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8046 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8047 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8048 @end deffn
8049
8050 @deffn {Command} sleep msec [@option{busy}]
8051 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8052 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8053 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8054 Useful in connection with script files
8055 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8056 @end deffn
8057
8058 @deffn {Command} shutdown [@option{error}]
8059 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8060 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8061 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8062
8063 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8064 @example
8065 # redefine shutdown
8066 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8067 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8068 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8069 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8070 original_shutdown
8071 @}
8072 @end example
8073 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8074 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8075 @end deffn
8076
8077 @anchor{debuglevel}
8078 @deffn {Command} debug_level [n]
8079 @cindex message level
8080 Display debug level.
8081 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8082 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8083 Level 0 is error messages only;
8084 level 1 adds warnings;
8085 level 2 adds informational messages;
8086 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8087 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8088 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8089 the command line along with the location of that log
8090 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8091 @xref{Running}.
8092 @end deffn
8093
8094 @deffn {Command} echo [-n] message
8095 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8096 Output @var{message} to stdout.
8097 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8098 @example
8099 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8100 @end example
8101 @end deffn
8102
8103 @deffn {Command} log_output [filename | "default"]
8104 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8105 the default log output channel is stderr.
8106 @end deffn
8107
8108 @deffn {Command} add_script_search_dir [directory]
8109 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8110 @end deffn
8111
8112 @deffn {Command} bindto [@var{name}]
8113 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8114 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8115 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8116 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8117 @end deffn
8118
8119 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8120 @section Target State handling
8121 @cindex reset
8122 @cindex halt
8123 @cindex target initialization
8124
8125 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8126 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8127 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8128 a current target which is used to perform the
8129 various operations. The current target may be changed
8130 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8131 target which should become current.
8132
8133 @deffn {Command} reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8134 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8135 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8136 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8137 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8138
8139 @emph{With no arguments}:
8140 list all available registers for the current target,
8141 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8142 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8143 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8144 are flagged as such.
8145
8146 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8147 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8148 bypassing any internal cache.
8149
8150 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8151 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8152 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8153 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8154 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8155 relevant module will flush such values.
8156
8157 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8158 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8159
8160 @example
8161 > reg
8162 ===== ARM registers
8163 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8164 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8165 (2) r2 (/32)
8166 ...
8167 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8168 >
8169 @end example
8170 @end deffn
8171
8172 @deffn {Command} halt [ms]
8173 @deffnx {Command} wait_halt [ms]
8174 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8175 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8176 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8177 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8178 (and enter debug mode).
8179 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8180
8181 @quotation Warning
8182 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8183 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8184 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8185 power mode by gating the core clock;
8186 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8187
8188 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8189 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8190 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8191 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8192 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8193 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8194
8195 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8196 work with a JTAG debugger.
8197 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8198 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8199 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8200 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8201 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8202 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8203 @end quotation
8204
8205 @end deffn
8206
8207 @deffn {Command} resume [address]
8208 Resume the target at its current code position,
8209 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8210 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8211 @end deffn
8212
8213 @deffn {Command} step [address]
8214 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8215 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8216 @end deffn
8217
8218 @anchor{resetcommand}
8219 @deffn {Command} reset
8220 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8221 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8222 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8223 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8224 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8225 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8226
8227 The optional parameter specifies what should
8228 happen after the reset.
8229 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8230 The other options will not work on all systems.
8231 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8232
8233 @itemize @minus
8234 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8235 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8236 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8237 @end itemize
8238 @end deffn
8239
8240 @deffn {Command} soft_reset_halt
8241 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8242 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8243 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8244 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8245 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8246 state.
8247 @end deffn
8248
8249 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8250 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8251 Set values of reset signals.
8252 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8253 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8254 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8255 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8256
8257 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8258 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8259 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8260 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8261 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8262 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8263 the signal will not be modified.
8264
8265 @quotation Note
8266 TRST is specially handled.
8267 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8268 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8269 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8270 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8271 instead of the TRST signal.
8272 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8273 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8274 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8275 with handlers for that event.
8276 @end quotation
8277 @end deffn
8278
8279 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8280 @section Memory access commands
8281 @cindex memory access
8282
8283 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8284 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8285 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8286 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8287
8288 @enumerate
8289 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8290 to change the current target.
8291 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8292 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8293 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8294 @end enumerate
8295
8296 @deffn {Command} mdd [phys] addr [count]
8297 @deffnx {Command} mdw [phys] addr [count]
8298 @deffnx {Command} mdh [phys] addr [count]
8299 @deffnx {Command} mdb [phys] addr [count]
8300 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8301 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8302 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8303 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8304 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8305 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8306 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8307 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8308 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8309 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8310 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8311 @end deffn
8312
8313 @deffn {Command} mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8314 @deffnx {Command} mww [phys] addr word [count]
8315 @deffnx {Command} mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8316 @deffnx {Command} mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8317 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8318 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8319 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8320 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8321 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8322 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8323 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8324 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8325 @end deffn
8326
8327 @anchor{imageaccess}
8328 @section Image loading commands
8329 @cindex image loading
8330 @cindex image dumping
8331
8332 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8333 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8334 binary file named @var{filename}.
8335 @end deffn
8336
8337 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8338 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8339 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8340 @end deffn
8341
8342 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8343 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8344 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8345 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8346 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8347 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8348 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8349 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8350 separately.
8351 @end deffn
8352
8353 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8354 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8355 The file format may optionally be specified
8356 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8357 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8358 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8359 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8360 @example
8361 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8362 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8363 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8364 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8365 $address $length
8366 @}
8367 @end example
8368 @end deffn
8369
8370 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8371 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8372 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8373 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8374 The file format may optionally be specified
8375 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8376 @end deffn
8377
8378 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8379 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8380 The file format may optionally be specified
8381 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8382 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8383 @end deffn
8384
8385 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8386 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8387 The file format may optionally be specified
8388 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8389 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8390 @end deffn
8391
8392
8393 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8394 @cindex breakpoint
8395 @cindex watchpoint
8396
8397 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8398 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8399 watchpoints.
8400 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8401
8402 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8403 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8404 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8405 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8406 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8407 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8408
8409 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8410 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8411 @end deffn
8412
8413 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8414 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8415 @end deffn
8416
8417 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8418 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8419 @end deffn
8420
8421 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8422 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8423 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8424 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8425 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8426 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8427 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8428 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8429 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8430 @end deffn
8431
8432
8433 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8434
8435 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8436 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8437 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8438 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8439 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8440 running, can be used.
8441 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8442 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8443 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8444
8445 @quotation Note
8446 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8447 @end quotation
8448
8449 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8450 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8451 communication, respectively.
8452
8453 @quotation Note
8454 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8455 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8456 example.
8457 @end quotation
8458
8459 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8460 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8461 of TCP/IP connections.
8462
8463 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8464 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8465 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8466 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8467 @var{size} bytes.
8468 @end deffn
8469
8470 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8471 Start RTT.
8472 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8473 @end deffn
8474
8475 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8476 Stop RTT.
8477 @end deffn
8478
8479 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8480 Display the polling interval.
8481 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8482 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8483 checked for new data.
8484 @end deffn
8485
8486 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8487 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8488 @end deffn
8489
8490 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8491 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8492 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8493 @end deffn
8494
8495 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8496 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8497 @end deffn
8498
8499 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8500 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8501 @end deffn
8502
8503 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8504 on the target device.
8505
8506 @example
8507 resume
8508
8509 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8510 rtt start
8511
8512 rtt server start 9090 0
8513 @end example
8514
8515 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8516 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8517 TCP/IP port 9090.
8518
8519
8520 @section Misc Commands
8521
8522 @cindex profiling
8523 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8524 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8525 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8526 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8527 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8528 limit the address range.
8529 @end deffn
8530
8531 @deffn {Command} {version}
8532 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8533 @end deffn
8534
8535 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8536 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8537 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8538 @end deffn
8539
8540 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8541 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8542 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8543 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8544
8545 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8546 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8547 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8548 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8549
8550 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8551 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8552 @cindex tracing
8553 @cindex ETM
8554 @cindex ETB
8555
8556 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8557 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8558 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8559
8560 @itemize
8561 @item
8562 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8563 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8564 supports such an interface.
8565 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8566 and trace port support.)
8567 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8568 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8569 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8570 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8571 in the board-specific configuration file.
8572 @item
8573 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8574 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8575 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8576 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8577 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8578 @end itemize
8579
8580 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8581
8582 @quotation Issues
8583 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8584 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8585
8586 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8587 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8588 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8589 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8590 dummy trace port driver}.
8591
8592 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8593 as well as tracing only during specific states
8594 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8595
8596 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8597 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8598 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8599 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8600 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8601
8602 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8603 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8604 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8605 this original style of JTAG access.
8606 @end quotation
8607
8608 @subsection ETM Configuration
8609 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8610
8611 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8612 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8613 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8614
8615 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8616 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8617 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8618 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8619 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8620 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8621 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8622 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8623 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8624
8625 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8626 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8627 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8628
8629 @quotation Warning
8630 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8631 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8632 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8633 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8634 @end quotation
8635
8636 @quotation Note
8637 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8638 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8639 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8640 what CPU activities are traced.
8641 @end quotation
8642 @end deffn
8643
8644 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8645 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8646 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8647 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8648 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8649 @end deffn
8650
8651 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8652 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8653 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8654 Did trace data overflow?
8655 Was it triggered?
8656 @end deffn
8657
8658 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8659 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8660 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8661 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8662 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8663
8664 @itemize
8665 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8666 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8667 The value is one of
8668 @option{none} (save nothing),
8669 @option{data} (save data),
8670 @option{address} (save addresses),
8671 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8672 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8673 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8674 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8675 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8676 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8677 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8678 trace stream without an image of the code.
8679 @end itemize
8680 @end deffn
8681
8682 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8683 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8684 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8685 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8686 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8687
8688 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8689 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8690 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8691 @end deffn
8692
8693 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8694
8695 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8696 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8697 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8698
8699 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8700 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8701 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8702 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8703 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8704 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8705 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8706
8707 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8708
8709 @itemize
8710 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8711 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8712 for instruction access within that function's body.
8713 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8714 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8715 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8716 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8717 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8718 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8719 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8720 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8721 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8722 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8723 @item @emph{... more}
8724 @end itemize
8725
8726 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8727 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8728
8729 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8730 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8731 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8732 @end deffn
8733
8734 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8735 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8736 @end deffn
8737
8738 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8739 Opens an image file.
8740 @end deffn
8741
8742 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8743 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8744 @end deffn
8745
8746 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8747 Starts trace data collection.
8748 @end deffn
8749
8750 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8751 Stops trace data collection.
8752 @end deffn
8753
8754 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8755 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8756
8757 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8758
8759 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8760 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8761 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8762 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8763 any trace data collection.}
8764 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8765 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8766 @end deffn
8767 @end deffn
8768
8769 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8770 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8771 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8772 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8773 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8774 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8775 @end deffn
8776 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8777 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8778 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8779 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8780 trace trigger becomes active.
8781
8782 @itemize
8783 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8784 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8785 afterwards.
8786 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8787 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8788 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8789 what caused that event to happen.
8790 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8791 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8792 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8793 how the event caused trouble.
8794 @end itemize
8795 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8796 @end deffn
8797
8798 @end deffn
8799
8800 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8801 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8802 @cindex CTI
8803
8804 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8805 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8806 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8807 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8808 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8809 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8810
8811 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8812 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8813 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8814 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8815 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8816 including additional configuration.
8817 @end deffn
8818
8819 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8820 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8821 @end deffn
8822
8823 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
8824 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8825 @end deffn
8826
8827 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8828 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8829 @end deffn
8830
8831 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8832 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8833 @end deffn
8834
8835 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8836 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8837 @end deffn
8838
8839 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8840 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8841 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8842 @end deffn
8843
8844 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8845 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8846 of the CTI.
8847 @end deffn
8848
8849 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
8850 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8851 useful in TCL scripting.
8852 @end deffn
8853
8854 @section Generic ARM
8855 @cindex ARM
8856
8857 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8858 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8859 commands that may be available.
8860
8861 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8862 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8863 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8864 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8865 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8866 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8867 @end deffn
8868
8869 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8870 @cindex disassemble
8871 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8872 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8873 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8874 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8875 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8876 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8877 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8878
8879 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8880 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8881 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8882 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8883 with a handful of exceptions.
8884 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8885 @end deffn
8886
8887 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8888 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8889 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8890 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8891 and using the MCR instruction.
8892 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8893 an ARM register.)
8894 @end deffn
8895
8896 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8897 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8898 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8899 and the MRC instruction.
8900 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8901 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8902 an ARM register.)
8903 @end deffn
8904
8905 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
8906 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8907 core mode if necessary.
8908 @end deffn
8909
8910 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8911 @cindex ARM semihosting
8912 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8913
8914 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8915 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8916 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8917 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8918 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8919 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8920 @end deffn
8921
8922 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8923 @cindex ARM semihosting
8924 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8925
8926 @example
8927 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8928 @end example
8929
8930 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8931 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8932 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8933 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8934 @end deffn
8935
8936 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8937 @cindex ARM semihosting
8938 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8939 status.
8940
8941 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8942 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8943 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8944 debugger.
8945 @end deffn
8946
8947 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8948 @cindex ARM semihosting
8949 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8950
8951 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8952 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8953 the value returned by the target.
8954
8955 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8956 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8957 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8958 encountering a break.
8959
8960 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8961 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8962 to the debugger.
8963 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8964 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8965 request or equivalent").
8966
8967 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8968 this option (default: disabled).
8969 @end deffn
8970
8971 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8972 @cindex ARMv4
8973 @cindex ARMv5
8974
8975 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8976 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8977 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8978 variant.
8979
8980 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8981 @cindex ARM7
8982 @cindex ARM9
8983
8984 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8985 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8986 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8987 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8988
8989 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8990 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8991 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8992 instead of breakpoints.
8993 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8994
8995 This should be
8996 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8997 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8998 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8999 @end deffn
9000
9001 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9002 @cindex DCC
9003 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9004 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9005 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9006
9007 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9008 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9009 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9010 @end deffn
9011
9012 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9013 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9014 that don't check completion of the operation.
9015 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9016
9017 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9018 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9019 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9020 @end deffn
9021
9022 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9023 @cindex ARM9
9024
9025 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9026 integer processors.
9027 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9028
9029 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9030 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9031 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9032 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9033
9034 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9035 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9036 @cindex vector_catch
9037 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9038 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9039 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9040 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9041 to those hardware vectors.
9042
9043 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9044 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9045 vector catch hardware to intercept
9046 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9047 @option{none} of them,
9048 or a list with one or more of the following:
9049 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9050 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9051 @end deffn
9052
9053 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9054 @cindex ARM920T
9055
9056 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9057 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9058 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9059 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9060 and ARM9 commands.
9061
9062 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9063 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9064 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9065 @end deffn
9066
9067 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9068 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9069 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9070 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9071 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9072 (Not all registers can be written.)
9073 @end deffn
9074
9075 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9076 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9077 @end deffn
9078
9079 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9080 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9081 @end deffn
9082
9083 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9084 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9085
9086 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9087 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9088 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9089 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9090 and ARM9 commands.
9091
9092 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9093 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9094
9095 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9096 Print information about the caches found.
9097 @end deffn
9098
9099 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9100 @cindex ARM966E
9101
9102 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9103 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9104 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9105 and ARM9 commands.
9106
9107 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9108 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9109 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9110 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9111 ARM966E-S TRM.
9112 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9113 as required for BIST support.
9114 @end deffn
9115
9116 @subsection XScale specific commands
9117 @cindex XScale
9118
9119 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9120
9121 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9122 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9123 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9124 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9125 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9126 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9127 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9128
9129 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9130 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9131 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9132 the mini-IC.
9133
9134 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9135 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9136 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9137 code layout in memory:
9138 @example
9139 _vectors:
9140 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9141 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9142 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9143 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9144 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9145 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9146 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9147 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9148 .org 0x100
9149 .long real_reset_vector
9150 .long real_ui_handler
9151 .long real_swi_handler
9152 .long real_pf_abort
9153 .long real_data_abort
9154 .long 0 /* unused */
9155 .long real_irq_handler
9156 .long real_fiq_handler
9157 @end example
9158
9159 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9160 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9161 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9162 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9163 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9164 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9165 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9166 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9167 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9168 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9169 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9170 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9171 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9172 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9173 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9174 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9175 software.
9176
9177 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9178 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9179 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9180 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9181
9182 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9183 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9184 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9185 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9186 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9187 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9188 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9189 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9190 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9191
9192 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9193 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9194
9195 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9196 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9197 @end deffn
9198
9199 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9200 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9201 @end deffn
9202
9203 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9204 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9205 @end deffn
9206
9207 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9208 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9209 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9210 @end deffn
9211
9212 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9213 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9214 @end deffn
9215
9216 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9217 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9218 @end deffn
9219
9220 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9221 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9222 @end deffn
9223
9224 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9225 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9226 @end deffn
9227
9228 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9229 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9230 @end deffn
9231
9232 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9233 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9234 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9235 and modifying how it is emptied.
9236 @end deffn
9237
9238 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9239 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9240 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9241 The image @var{type} may be one of
9242 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9243 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9244 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9245 @end deffn
9246
9247 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9248 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9249 @cindex vector_catch
9250 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9251 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9252
9253 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9254 @example
9255 0x01 Trap Reset
9256 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9257 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9258 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9259 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9260 0x20 reserved
9261 0x40 Trap IRQ
9262 0x80 Trap FIQ
9263 @end example
9264 @end deffn
9265
9266 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9267 @cindex vector_table
9268
9269 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9270 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9271 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9272 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9273 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9274
9275 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9276
9277 @end deffn
9278
9279 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9280 @cindex ARMv6
9281
9282 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9283 @cindex ARM11
9284
9285 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9286 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9287 which is enabled by default.
9288 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9289 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9290 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9291 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9292 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9293 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9294 @end deffn
9295
9296 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9297 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9298 which is enabled by default.
9299 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9300 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9301 @end deffn
9302
9303 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9304 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9305 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9306 they are disabled by default.
9307 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9308 @end deffn
9309
9310 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9311 @cindex vector_catch
9312 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9313 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9314 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9315
9316 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9317 for certain hardware events.
9318 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9319 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9320 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9321 @end deffn
9322
9323 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9324 @cindex ARMv7
9325 @cindex ARMv8
9326
9327 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9328 @cindex Cortex-A
9329
9330 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9331 display information about target caches
9332 @end deffn
9333
9334 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9335 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9336 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9337 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9338 Defaults to 'off'.
9339 @end deffn
9340
9341 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9342 Initialize core debug
9343 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9344 @end deffn
9345
9346 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9347 Display/set the current SMP mode
9348 @end deffn
9349
9350 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9351 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9352 @end deffn
9353
9354 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9355 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9356 @end deffn
9357
9358 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9359 configure l2x cache
9360 @end deffn
9361
9362 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9363 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9364 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9365 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9366 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9367 @end deffn
9368
9369 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9370 @cindex Cortex-R
9371
9372 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r dbginit}
9373 Initialize core debug
9374 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9375 @end deffn
9376
9377 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9378 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9379 @end deffn
9380
9381
9382 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9383 @cindex tracing
9384 @cindex SWO
9385 @cindex SWV
9386 @cindex TPIU
9387
9388 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9389 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9390 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9391 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9392
9393 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9394 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9395 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9396 which causes quite some confusion.
9397 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9398 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9399
9400 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9401 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9402 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9403
9404 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9405 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9406 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9407 @end deffn
9408
9409 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9410 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9411 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9412 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9413
9414 @itemize @bullet
9415 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9416 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9417 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9418 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9419
9420 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9421 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9422 @end itemize
9423 @end deffn
9424
9425 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9426 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9427 @end deffn
9428
9429 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9430 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9431 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9432 at any time after the initialization, too.
9433 @end deffn
9434
9435 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9436 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9437 individually queried, to return its current value.
9438 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9439 @end deffn
9440
9441 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9442 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9443 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9444 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9445
9446 @itemize @bullet
9447 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9448 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9449
9450 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9451 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9452
9453 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9454 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9455
9456 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9457 protocol used for trace data:
9458 @itemize @minus
9459 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9460 data bits (default);
9461 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9462 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9463 @end itemize
9464
9465 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9466 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9467 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9468 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9469 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9470 of the TPIU.
9471
9472 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9473 the destination of the trace data:
9474 @itemize @minus
9475 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9476 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9477 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9478 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9479 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9480 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9481 each connected client;
9482 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9483 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9484 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9485 @end itemize
9486
9487 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9488 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9489 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9490 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9491
9492 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9493 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9494 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9495 maximum supported rate automatically.
9496
9497 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9498 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9499 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9500
9501 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9502 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9503 default value is @var{0}.
9504 @end itemize
9505 @end deffn
9506
9507 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9508 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9509 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9510 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9511 data.
9512 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9513 after the @command{init}.
9514 @end deffn
9515
9516 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9517 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9518 @end deffn
9519
9520
9521
9522 Example usage:
9523 @enumerate
9524 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9525 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9526 enough to:
9527 @example
9528 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9529 ...
9530 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9531 ...
9532 @end example
9533 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9534 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9535 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9536 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9537 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9538 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9539 @example
9540 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9541 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9542 @end example
9543 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9544 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9545 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9546 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9547 @example
9548 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9549 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9550 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9551 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9552 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9553 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9554 @end example
9555 @end enumerate
9556
9557 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9558 @cindex tracing
9559 @cindex SWO
9560 @cindex SWV
9561 @cindex ITM
9562 @cindex ETM
9563
9564 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9565 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9566 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9567 @end deffn
9568
9569 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9570 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9571 @end deffn
9572
9573 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9574 @cindex Cortex-M
9575
9576 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9577 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9578
9579 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9580 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9581 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9582 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9583 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9584 the step command leaves with the core running.
9585
9586 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9587 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9588 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9589 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9590
9591 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9592 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9593 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9594 does.
9595
9596 Default is @option{auto}.
9597 @end deffn
9598
9599 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9600 @cindex vector_catch
9601 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9602 for certain hardware events.
9603
9604 Parameters request interception of
9605 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9606 @option{none} of them,
9607 or one or more of the following:
9608 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9609 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9610 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9611 @option{irq_err},
9612 @option{state_err},
9613 @option{chk_err}, or
9614 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9615 @option{reset}.
9616 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9617 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9618 are mapped to HardFault.
9619 UsageFault checks for
9620 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9621 must also be explicitly enabled.
9622
9623 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9624 @end deffn
9625
9626 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9627 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9628 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9629
9630 @itemize @minus
9631 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9632 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9633 @end itemize
9634
9635 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9636 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9637 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9638 to manually reset the peripherals.
9639 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9640
9641 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9642 instead.
9643 @end deffn
9644
9645 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9646 @cindex ARMv8-A
9647 @cindex aarch64
9648
9649 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9650 Display information about target caches
9651 @end deffn
9652
9653 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9654 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9655 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9656 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9657 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9658 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9659 @end deffn
9660
9661 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9662 @cindex disassemble
9663 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9664 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9665 @end deffn
9666
9667 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9668 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9669 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9670 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9671 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9672 @end deffn
9673
9674 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9675 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9676 @option{on}.
9677 @end deffn
9678
9679 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9680 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9681 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9682 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9683 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9684 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9685 @end deffn
9686
9687 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9688
9689 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9690 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9691
9692 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9693
9694 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9695 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9696 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9697 @end deffn
9698
9699 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9700 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9701 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9702 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9703 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9704 @end deffn
9705
9706 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9707
9708 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9709 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9710 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9711 @end deffn
9712
9713 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9714
9715 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9716 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9717 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9718 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9719 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9720 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9721 can be collected.
9722
9723 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9724 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9725 tooling.
9726
9727 @quotation Issues
9728 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9729 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9730 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9731 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9732
9733 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9734 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9735 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9736 software operation on the CPU.
9737 @end quotation
9738
9739 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9740 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9741 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9742 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9743 @end deffn
9744
9745 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9746 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9747 @end deffn
9748
9749 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9750 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9751 control is disabled.
9752 @end deffn
9753
9754 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9755 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9756 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9757 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9758
9759 Supported trace formats:
9760 @itemize
9761 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9762 timing to be determined.
9763 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9764 addresses.
9765 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9766 @end itemize
9767 @end deffn
9768
9769 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9770 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9771 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9772 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9773
9774 Supported conditions:
9775 @itemize
9776 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9777 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9778 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9779 instruction matches start data and mask.
9780 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9781 instruction matches start data and mask.
9782 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9783 data and mask.
9784 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9785 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9786 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9787 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9788 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9789 @end itemize
9790 @end deffn
9791
9792 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9793 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9794 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9795 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9796
9797 Supported conditions:
9798 @itemize
9799 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9800 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9801 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9802 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9803 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9804 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9805 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9806 data and mask.
9807 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9808 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9809 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9810 @end itemize
9811 @end deffn
9812
9813 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9814 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9815
9816 Supported triggers:
9817 @itemize
9818 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9819 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9820 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9821 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9822 collection.
9823 @end itemize
9824 @end deffn
9825
9826 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9827
9828 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
9829 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9830 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9831 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9832 @end deffn
9833
9834 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
9835 Display trace configuration.
9836 @end deffn
9837
9838 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
9839 Display trace collection status.
9840 @end deffn
9841
9842 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
9843 Start manual trace collection.
9844 @end deffn
9845
9846 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
9847 Stop manual trace collection.
9848 @end deffn
9849
9850 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9851 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9852 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9853 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9854 @option{size} options using DMA.
9855 @end deffn
9856
9857 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9858 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9859 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9860 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9861 @option{size} options using DMA.
9862 @end deffn
9863
9864 @section Intel Architecture
9865
9866 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9867 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9868 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9869 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9870 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9871 @itemize
9872 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9873 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9874 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9875 @end itemize
9876
9877 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9878 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9879 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9880
9881 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
9882 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9883 @end deffn
9884
9885 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
9886 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9887 @end deffn
9888
9889 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
9890 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9891 @end deffn
9892
9893 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
9894 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9895 @end deffn
9896
9897 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
9898 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9899 @end deffn
9900
9901 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
9902 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9903 @end deffn
9904
9905 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9906
9907 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9908 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9909
9910 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9911 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9912 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9913 @end deffn
9914 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9915 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9916
9917 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9918
9919 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9920 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9921 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9922 @end deffn
9923
9924 @subsection Registers commands
9925 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9926 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9927 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9928
9929 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9930
9931 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9932 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9933 and "timer" groups.
9934
9935 @emph{example:}
9936 @example
9937 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9938 @end example
9939
9940
9941 @end deffn
9942 @deffn {Command} {readgroup} (@option{group})
9943 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9944
9945 @emph{group} can be "system",
9946 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9947 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9948 @end deffn
9949
9950 @section RISC-V Architecture
9951
9952 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9953 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9954 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9955 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9956 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9957 implement version 0.11.
9958
9959 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9960
9961 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9962 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9963 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9964
9965 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9966
9967 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9968 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9969 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9970
9971 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9972 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9973 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9974 CSRs.
9975 @end deffn
9976
9977 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9978 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9979 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9980 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9981 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9982 This command must be executed before `init`.
9983 @end deffn
9984
9985 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9986 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9987 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9988 @end deffn
9989
9990 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9991 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9992 deasserted.
9993 @end deffn
9994
9995 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9996 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9997 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9998 @end deffn
9999
10000 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10001 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10002 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10003 @end deffn
10004
10005 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10006 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10007 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10008 on physical memory.
10009 @end deffn
10010
10011 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10012 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10013 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10014 performed on physical memory.
10015 @end deffn
10016
10017 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10018 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10019 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10020 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10021 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10022 race condition problem in your code.
10023
10024 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10025 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10026 @end deffn
10027
10028 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10029 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10030 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10031 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10032 values.
10033
10034 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10035 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10036 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10037 @end deffn
10038
10039 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10040 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10041 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10042 @end deffn
10043
10044 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10045 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10046 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10047 @end deffn
10048
10049 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10050 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10051 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10052 @end deffn
10053
10054 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10055 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10056 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10057 @end deffn
10058
10059 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10060
10061 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10062 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10063 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10064 @example
10065 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10066 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10067 @end example
10068
10069 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10070 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10071 @end deffn
10072
10073 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10074 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10075 @end deffn
10076
10077 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10078
10079 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10080 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10081
10082 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10083 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10084 @end deffn
10085
10086 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10087 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10088 @end deffn
10089
10090 @section ARC Architecture
10091 @cindex ARC
10092
10093 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10094 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10095 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10096 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10097 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10098 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10099 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10100 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10101 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10102 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10103 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10104 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10105 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10106 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10107 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10108
10109
10110 @subsection General ARC commands
10111
10112 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10113
10114 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10115 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10116 arguments:
10117
10118 @itemize @bullet
10119
10120 @item @code{-name} name
10121 @*Name of a register.
10122
10123 @item @code{-num} number
10124 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10125
10126 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10127 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10128
10129 @end itemize
10130
10131 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10132
10133 @itemize @bullet
10134
10135 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10136 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10137 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10138 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10139 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10140 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10141
10142 @item @code{-core}
10143 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10144 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10145 spaces.
10146
10147 @item @code{-bcr}
10148 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10149 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10150 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10151 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10152 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10153
10154 @item @code{-type} type_name
10155 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10156 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10157
10158 @item @code{-g}
10159 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10160 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10161 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10162 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10163 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10164
10165 @end itemize
10166
10167 @end deffn
10168
10169 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10170 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10171 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10172 @end deffn
10173
10174 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10175 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10176 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10177 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10178 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10179 startbit endbit}.
10180 @end deffn
10181
10182 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10183 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10184 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
10185 @end deffn
10186
10187 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10188 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10189 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10190 @end deffn
10191
10192 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10193
10194 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10195 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10196 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10197 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10198
10199 @end deffn
10200
10201 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10202 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10203 registers.
10204 @end deffn
10205
10206 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10207 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10208 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10209 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10210
10211 @end deffn
10212
10213 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10214 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10215 registers.
10216 @end deffn
10217
10218 @section STM8 Architecture
10219 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10220 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10221
10222 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10223 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10224
10225 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10226 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10227 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10228 @cindex tracing
10229 @cindex libdcc
10230 @cindex DCC
10231 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10232 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10233 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10234 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10235
10236 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10237 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10238 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10239 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10240 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10241 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10242
10243 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10244 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10245 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10246 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10247 The target being debugged may
10248 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10249 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10250 each supported by a command:
10251
10252 @itemize
10253 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10254 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10255 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10256 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10257
10258 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10259 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10260 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10261
10262 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10263 and then displayed at any time.
10264 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10265
10266 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10267 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10268 @end itemize
10269
10270 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10271 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10272 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10273 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10274 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10275 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10276 does the same thing.
10277
10278 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10279 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10280 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10281 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10282 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10283
10284 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10285 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10286 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10287 @end deffn
10288
10289 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10290 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10291 in the order they triggered.
10292 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10293 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10294 history records.
10295 @end deffn
10296
10297 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10298 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10299 they have been triggered.
10300 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10301 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10302 and associates it with that identifier.
10303
10304 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10305 are not related except by this command.
10306 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10307 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10308 @end deffn
10309
10310
10311 @node JTAG Commands
10312 @chapter JTAG Commands
10313 @cindex JTAG Commands
10314 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10315 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10316 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10317 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10318 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10319
10320 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10321 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10322
10323 @itemize @bullet
10324 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10325 devices such as a CPUs.
10326 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10327 standard state machine (in parallel)
10328 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10329 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10330 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10331 while the reading previous ones.
10332 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10333 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10334 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10335 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10336 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10337 registers.
10338 @end itemize
10339
10340 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10341
10342 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10343 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10344 the order of TAP state transitions.
10345 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10346 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10347 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10348 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10349 these commands are not available.
10350
10351 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10352 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10353 that specify the entire register.
10354 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10355 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10356 The return value holds the original value of each
10357 of those fields.
10358
10359 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10360 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10361 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10362 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10363 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10364
10365 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10366 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10367
10368 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10369 in that state.
10370 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10371 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10372 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10373
10374 @quotation Warning
10375 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10376 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10377 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10378 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10379 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10380 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10381 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10382 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10383 @end quotation
10384 @end deffn
10385
10386 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10387 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10388 This may be used for performance tuning.
10389
10390 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10391 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10392 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10393 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10394 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10395 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10396 @end deffn
10397
10398 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10399 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10400 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10401 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10402 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10403 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10404
10405 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10406 in that state.
10407 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10408 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10409 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10410
10411 @quotation Note
10412 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10413 register values, unlike data register values.
10414 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10415 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10416 @end quotation
10417 @end deffn
10418
10419 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10420 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10421 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10422 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10423 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10424 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10425 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10426 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10427 The final state must also be stable.
10428 @end deffn
10429
10430 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10431 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10432 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10433 Instructions often need some time
10434 to execute before they take effect.
10435 @end deffn
10436
10437 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10438 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10439
10440 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10441 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10442 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10443 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10444 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10445 @end deffn
10446
10447 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10448 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10449 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10450 must also be enabled.
10451 Default is enabled.
10452 @end deffn
10453
10454 @section TAP state names
10455 @cindex TAP state names
10456
10457 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10458 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10459 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10460 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10461
10462 @itemize @bullet
10463 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10464 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10465 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10466 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10467 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10468 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10469 through the data register
10470 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10471 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10472 for update or more shifting
10473 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10474 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10475 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10476 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10477 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10478 through the instruction register
10479 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10480 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10481 for update or more shifting
10482 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10483 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10484 @end itemize
10485
10486 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10487 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10488 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10489 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10490
10491 @itemize @bullet
10492 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10493 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10494 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10495 may not be as expected.
10496 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10497 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10498 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10499 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10500 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10501 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10502 @end itemize
10503
10504 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10505 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10506
10507 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10508 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10509 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10510 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10511
10512 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10513 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10514 @cindex SVF
10515
10516 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10517 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10518 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10519 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10520
10521 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10522 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10523 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10524 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10525
10526 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10527 affect their semantics.
10528
10529 Command options:
10530 @itemize @minus
10531 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10532 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10533 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10534 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10535 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10536 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10537 on the real interface;
10538 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10539 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10540 errors.
10541 @end itemize
10542 @end deffn
10543
10544 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10545 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10546 @cindex XSVF
10547
10548 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10549 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10550 Xilinx devices.
10551 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10552 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10553
10554 @quotation Important
10555 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10556 @end quotation
10557
10558 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10559 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10560 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10561 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10562 that TAP.
10563 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10564 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10565 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10566 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10567 @end deffn
10568
10569 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10570 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10571 after building the software.
10572 You may find them useful:
10573
10574 @itemize
10575 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10576 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10577 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10578 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10579 @end itemize
10580
10581 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10582 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10583 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10584 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10585 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10586 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10587 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10588
10589
10590 @node Utility Commands
10591 @chapter Utility Commands
10592 @cindex Utility Commands
10593
10594 @section RAM testing
10595 @cindex RAM testing
10596
10597 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10598 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10599 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10600 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10601 hardware problems.
10602
10603 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10604 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10605 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10606 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10607
10608 Load the memory testing functions with
10609
10610 @example
10611 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10612 @end example
10613
10614 to get access to the following facilities:
10615
10616 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10617 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10618 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10619 @end deffn
10620
10621 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10622 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10623 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10624 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10625 @end deffn
10626
10627 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10628 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10629 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10630 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10631 @end deffn
10632
10633 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10634 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10635 @end deffn
10636
10637 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10638 @cindex Firmware recovery
10639
10640 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10641 devices recovery with JTAG.
10642
10643 For quickstart instructions run:
10644 @example
10645 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10646 @end example
10647
10648 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10649 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10650 @cindex GDB
10651 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10652 to debug remote targets.
10653 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10654
10655 @itemize
10656 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10657 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10658 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10659 as shown in this chapter.
10660 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10661 that also will probably need to be configured.
10662 @end itemize
10663
10664 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10665 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10666 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10667 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10668 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10669 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10670
10671 @section Connecting to GDB
10672 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10673 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10674 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10675 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10676 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10677
10678 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10679
10680 @enumerate
10681 @item
10682 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10683 @example
10684 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10685 @end example
10686 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10687
10688 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10689 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10690 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10691
10692 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10693 remote command above that becomes:
10694 @example
10695 tar ext :3333
10696 @end example
10697
10698 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10699 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10700 available through the command:
10701 @example
10702 target remote localhost:3333
10703 @end example
10704
10705 @item
10706 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10707 @example
10708 target extended-remote | \
10709 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10710 @end example
10711 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10712 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10713 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10714 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10715 @end enumerate
10716
10717 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10718 GDB command line.
10719
10720 @section Sample GDB session startup
10721
10722 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10723 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10724 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10725 small ARM program.
10726 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10727 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10728
10729 @example
10730 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10731 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10732 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10733 ...
10734 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10735 ...
10736 (gdb) load
10737 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10738 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10739 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10740 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10741 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10742 (gdb) continue
10743 Continuing.
10744 ...
10745 @end example
10746
10747 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10748 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10749 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10750 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10751
10752 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10753
10754 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10755 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10756 packet size and the device's memory map.
10757 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10758 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10759 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10760
10761 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10762 You may need to set those up by hand.
10763 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10764 something like:
10765
10766 @example
10767 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10768 @end example
10769
10770 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10771
10772 @example
10773 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10774 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10775 @end example
10776
10777 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10778 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10779 do not have such restrictions.
10780
10781 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10782 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10783 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10784 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10785
10786 @section Programming using GDB
10787 @cindex Programming using GDB
10788 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10789
10790 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10791 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10792 @example
10793 gdb_memory_map disable
10794 @end example
10795 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10796 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10797 working area.
10798
10799 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10800 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10801 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10802 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10803
10804 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10805 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10806
10807 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10808 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10809 @example
10810 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10811 @end example
10812
10813 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10814 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10815
10816 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10817 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10818 will be used.
10819
10820 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10821 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10822 @example
10823 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10824 @end example
10825 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10826
10827 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10828 can be used.
10829
10830 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10831 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10832 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10833
10834 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10835 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10836 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10837
10838 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10839 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10840 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10841 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10842 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10843 without any intrusion of the target process.
10844
10845 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10846 Place following command after target configuration:
10847 @example
10848 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10849 @end example
10850
10851 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10852 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10853 @example
10854 gdb_memory_map disable
10855 @end example
10856
10857 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10858 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10859 @example
10860 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10861 @end example
10862
10863 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10864 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10865
10866 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10867 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10868 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10869 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10870
10871 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10872 previously shown variables.
10873
10874 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
10875 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
10876 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
10877 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
10878 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
10879
10880 @section RTOS Support
10881 @cindex RTOS Support
10882 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10883
10884 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10885 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10886
10887 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10888 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10889 GDB commands.
10890
10891 @* An example setup is below:
10892
10893 @example
10894 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10895 @end example
10896
10897 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10898
10899 Currently supported rtos's include:
10900 @itemize @bullet
10901 @item @option{eCos}
10902 @item @option{ThreadX}
10903 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10904 @item @option{linux}
10905 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10906 @item @option{embKernel}
10907 @item @option{mqx}
10908 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10909 @item @option{nuttx}
10910 @item @option{RIOT}
10911 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10912 @end itemize
10913
10914 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10915 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10916
10917 @table @code
10918 @item eCos symbols
10919 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10920 @item ThreadX symbols
10921 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10922 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10923 @raggedright
10924 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10925 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10926 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10927 @end raggedright
10928 @item linux symbols
10929 init_task.
10930 @item ChibiOS symbols
10931 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10932 @item embKernel symbols
10933 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10934 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10935 @item mqx symbols
10936 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10937 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10938 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
10939 @item nuttx symbols
10940 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
10941 @item RIOT symbols
10942 @raggedright
10943 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
10944 _tcb_name_offset.
10945 @end raggedright
10946 @end table
10947
10948 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10949 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10950
10951 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10952 along with the project:
10953
10954 @table @code
10955 @item FreeRTOS
10956 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10957 @item uC/OS-III
10958 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10959 @end table
10960
10961 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10962 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10963 @cindex SMP
10964 @cindex RTOS
10965 @cindex hwthread
10966 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10967 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10968 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10969 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10970 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10971 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10972 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10973 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10974 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10975
10976 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10977 @quotation Note
10978 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10979 @end quotation
10980
10981 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10982 @itemize @bullet
10983 @item j - smp status request
10984 @item J - smp set request
10985 @end itemize
10986
10987 OpenOCD implements :
10988 @itemize @bullet
10989 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10990 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10991 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10992 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10993 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10994 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10995 @end itemize
10996
10997 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10998 @itemize @bullet
10999 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11000 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11001 @example
11002 set $_core 1
11003 #Jc01 packet is sent
11004 print $_core
11005 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11006 @end example
11007
11008 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11009 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11010
11011 @example
11012 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11013 define toggle0
11014 maint packet Jc0
11015 continue
11016 main packet Jc-1
11017 end
11018 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11019 define toggle1
11020 maint packet Jc1
11021 continue
11022 main packet Jc-1
11023 end
11024 @end example
11025 @end itemize
11026
11027 @node Tcl Scripting API
11028 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11029 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11030 @cindex Tcl scripts
11031 @section API rules
11032
11033 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11034 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11035 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11036
11037 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11038 pair list and lists.
11039
11040 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11041 list.
11042
11043 @example
11044 > set foo(me) Duane
11045 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11046 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11047 > set foo(duck) Donald
11048 @end example
11049
11050 If one does this:
11051
11052 @example
11053 > set foo
11054 @end example
11055
11056 The result is:
11057
11058 @example
11059 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11060 @end example
11061
11062 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11063
11064 @verbatim
11065 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11066 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11067 }
11068 @end verbatim
11069
11070 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11071 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11072
11073 @section Internal low-level Commands
11074
11075 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
11076 invoke directly.
11077
11078 @itemize @bullet
11079 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11080
11081 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11082 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11083
11084 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11085 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11086
11087 Return information about the flash banks
11088
11089 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11090
11091 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11092 its execution. Example:
11093
11094 @example
11095 > capture "reset init"
11096 @end example
11097
11098 @end itemize
11099
11100 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11101 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11102 called "flash_banks".
11103
11104 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
11105
11106 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
11107 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
11108 holds one of the following values:
11109
11110 @itemize @bullet
11111 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
11112 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
11113 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
11114 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
11115 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
11116 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
11117 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
11118 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
11119 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
11120 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
11121 @end itemize
11122
11123 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
11124
11125 @quotation Note
11126 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
11127 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
11128 @code{jim_platform} (because it
11129 is jim, not real tcl).
11130 @end quotation
11131
11132 @section Tcl RPC server
11133 @cindex RPC
11134
11135 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11136 commands and receive the results.
11137
11138 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11139 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11140 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11141 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11142 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11143
11144 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11145 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11146 @command{capture} command.
11147
11148 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11149
11150 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11151 @cindex RPC Notifications
11152
11153 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11154 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11155
11156 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11157 in the following format.
11158
11159 @verbatim
11160 type target_event event [event-name]
11161 type target_state state [state-name]
11162 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11163 @end verbatim
11164
11165 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
11166 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11167 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11168 Defaults to off.
11169
11170 @end deffn
11171
11172 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11173 @cindex RPC trace output
11174
11175 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11176 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11177
11178 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11179
11180 @verbatim
11181 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11182 @end verbatim
11183
11184 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
11185 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11186 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11187 Defaults to off.
11188
11189 See an example application here:
11190 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11191
11192 @end deffn
11193
11194 @node FAQ
11195 @chapter FAQ
11196 @cindex faq
11197 @enumerate
11198 @anchor{faqrtck}
11199 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11200 @cindex RTCK
11201 @cindex adaptive clocking
11202 @*
11203
11204 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11205 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11206 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11207 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11208
11209 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11210 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11211 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11212 @enumerate
11213 @item
11214 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11215 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11216 @item
11217 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11218 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11219 @end enumerate
11220
11221 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11222 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11223 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11224 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11225 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11226 power).
11227
11228 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11229 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11230 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11231 ARM926 scenario).
11232 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11233 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11234 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11235
11236 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11237 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11238 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11239 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11240
11241 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11242
11243 In order to make use of this,
11244 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11245 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11246
11247 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11248 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11249 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11250 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11251 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11252
11253 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11254 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11255 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11256 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11257
11258 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11259 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11260 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11261 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11262 with a CPLD.
11263 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11264 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11265 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11266 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11267 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11268 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11269
11270 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11271
11272 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11273
11274 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11275 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11276 depending on the chips on your board.
11277 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11278 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11279 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11280
11281 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11282 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11283 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11284
11285 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11286 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11287 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11288 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11289
11290 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11291 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11292 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11293 this way.
11294
11295 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11296 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11297 clock rate.
11298 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11299 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11300 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11301
11302 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11303
11304 @example
11305 # Example: 1.234MHz
11306 adapter speed 1234
11307 @end example
11308
11309
11310 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11311
11312 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11313 around Windows filenames.
11314
11315 @example
11316 > echo \a
11317
11318 > echo @{\a@}
11319 \a
11320 > echo "\a"
11321
11322 >
11323 @end example
11324
11325
11326 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11327
11328 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11329 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11330 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11331
11332 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11333 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11334 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11335
11336 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11337 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11338 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11339
11340 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11341
11342 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11343 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11344 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11345 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11346
11347 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11348 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11349 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11350
11351 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11352 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11353
11354 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11355 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11356 memory read caused data abort".
11357
11358 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11359 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11360 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11361 be done, feel free to add this here.
11362
11363 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11364 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11365 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11366 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11367 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11368 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11369 gracefully stops.
11370
11371 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11372 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11373 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11374
11375 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11376 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11377 bytes. Painful...
11378
11379
11380 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11381 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11382
11383 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11384 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11385 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11386 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11387 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11388 reset, everything else should work fine.
11389
11390 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11391 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11392 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11393 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11394
11395 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11396 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11397 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11398 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11399
11400 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11401
11402 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11403 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11404 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11405
11406 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11407 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11408
11409 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11410 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11411 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11412 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11413 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11414 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11415 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11416 clock frequency?
11417
11418 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11419 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11420 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11421 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11422 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11423
11424 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11425
11426 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11427 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11428 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11429 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11430 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11431 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11432 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11433
11434 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11435
11436 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11437 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11438 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11439 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11440
11441 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11442 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11443 particular order?
11444
11445 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11446 the same order used by the hardware.
11447
11448 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11449 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11450 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11451 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11452 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11453 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11454
11455 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11456 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11457 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11458 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11459
11460 @itemize @bullet
11461 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11462 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11463 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11464 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11465 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11466 @end itemize
11467
11468 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11469
11470 @itemize @bullet
11471 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11472 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11473 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11474 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11475 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11476 @end itemize
11477
11478
11479 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11480 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11481 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11482
11483 TODO.
11484
11485 @end enumerate
11486
11487 @node Tcl Crash Course
11488 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11489 @cindex Tcl
11490
11491 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11492 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11493 how the Tcl scripts work.
11494
11495 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11496 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11497 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11498 OpenOCD.
11499
11500 @section Tcl Rule #1
11501 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11502 @enumerate
11503 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11504 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11505 @end enumerate
11506
11507 The Tcl equal is this:
11508
11509 @enumerate
11510 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11511 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11512 @end enumerate
11513
11514 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11515 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11516
11517 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11518 There is a second pair of rules.
11519 @enumerate
11520 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11521 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11522 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11523 in Tcl.
11524 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11525 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11526 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11527 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11528 @end enumerate
11529
11530 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11531 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11532 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11533 Everything is a string}
11534
11535 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11536 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11537 difference is subtle.
11538 @enumerate
11539 @item Parse Time
11540 @item Evaluation Time
11541 @end enumerate
11542
11543 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11544 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11545 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11546
11547 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11548 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11549 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11550 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11551
11552 @itemize @bullet
11553 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11554 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11555 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11556 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11557 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11558 @example
11559 # bash example
11560 X=`date`
11561 echo "The Date is: $X"
11562 # Tcl example
11563 set X [date]
11564 puts "The Date is: $X"
11565 @end example
11566 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11567 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11568 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11569 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11570 is a string}
11571 @example
11572 set x "Dinner"
11573 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11574 @end example
11575 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11576 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11577 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11578 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11579 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11580 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11581 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11582 @end itemize
11583
11584 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11585
11586 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11587
11588 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11589
11590 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11591 the normal way.
11592
11593 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11594 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11595 line is immediately executed.
11596
11597 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11598 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11599
11600 @subsection Command Execution
11601
11602 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11603 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11604 control flow operators.
11605
11606 Commands are executed like this:
11607
11608 @enumerate
11609 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11610 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11611 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11612 @end enumerate
11613
11614 It sort of works like this:
11615 @example
11616 for(;;)@{
11617 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11618
11619 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11620
11621 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11622 @}
11623 @end example
11624
11625 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11626 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11627 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11628 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11629 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11630 ``LookupCommand()''
11631
11632 @subsection The FOR command
11633
11634 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11635 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11636 command just like any other command.
11637
11638 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11639 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11640 are:
11641
11642 @enumerate 0
11643 @item The ascii text 'for'
11644 @item The start text
11645 @item The test expression
11646 @item The next text
11647 @item The body text
11648 @end enumerate
11649
11650 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11651 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11652 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11653 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11654
11655 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11656 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11657
11658 @example
11659 int
11660 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11661 int *argc,
11662 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11663 @end example
11664
11665 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11666 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11667 still operates in the same basic way.
11668
11669 @subsection FOR command implementation
11670
11671 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11672 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11673
11674 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11675
11676 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11677
11678 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11679 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11680 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11681
11682 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11683 expression and returns a value.
11684
11685 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11686 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11687 @example
11688 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11689
11690 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11691
11692 int
11693 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11694 int argc,
11695 char **argv )
11696 @{
11697 if( argc != 5 )@{
11698 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11699 return ERROR;
11700 @}
11701
11702 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11703
11704 // Execute the start statement.
11705 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11706
11707 // Top of loop test
11708 for(;;)@{
11709 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11710 if( i == 0 )
11711 break;
11712
11713 // Execute the body
11714 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11715
11716 // Execute the LOOP part
11717 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11718 @}
11719
11720 // Return no error
11721 SetResult( interp, "" );
11722 return SUCCESS;
11723 @}
11724 @end example
11725
11726 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11727 in the same basic way.
11728
11729 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11730
11731 @subsection source and find commands
11732 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11733 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11734 @*Remember the parsing rules
11735 @enumerate
11736 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11737 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11738 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11739 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11740 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11741 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11742 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11743 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11744 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11745 @end enumerate
11746 @subsection format command
11747 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11748 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11749 @b{sprintf()}.
11750 @b{Example}
11751 @example
11752 set x 6
11753 set y 7
11754 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11755 @end example
11756 @enumerate
11757 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11758 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11759 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11760 @* Refer to Rule #1
11761 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11762 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11763 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11764 @end enumerate
11765 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11766 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11767 @example
11768 #1 Good
11769 proc someproc @{@} @{
11770 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11771 @}
11772 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11773 #2 Good - no variables
11774 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11775 #3 Good Curly Braces
11776 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11777 puts "Time: [date]"
11778 @}
11779 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11780 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11781 @end example
11782 @enumerate
11783 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11784 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11785 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11786 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11787 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11788 command.
11789 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11790 @*There are 4 examples:
11791 @enumerate
11792 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11793 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11794 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11795 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11796 @end enumerate
11797
11798 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11799 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11800 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11801
11802 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11803 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11804 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11805 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11806 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11807 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11808 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11809 @end enumerate
11810 @subsection Global Variables
11811 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11812 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11813 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11814 @example
11815 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11816 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11817 global x #Global variable X
11818 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11819 @}
11820 @end example
11821 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11822 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11823 @example
11824 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11825 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11826 # Create var name
11827 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11828 # Make it a global
11829 global $vn
11830 # Set it.
11831 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11832 @}
11833 @end example
11834 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11835 @example
11836 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11837 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11838 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11839 @}
11840 @end example
11841
11842 @node License
11843 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
11844 @include fdl.texi
11845
11846 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11847 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11848 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11849 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11850 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11851 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11852
11853 @printindex cp
11854
11855 @node Command and Driver Index
11856 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11857 @printindex fn
11858
11859 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)